blob: 43d4760919491d468d5952724321f13af7de1e45 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau2e858402014-05-28 17:50:53 +02007 2014/05/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200500 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100501 - tune.zlib.memlevel
502 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 * Debugging
505 - debug
506 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507
508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510------------------------------------
511
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200512ca-base <dir>
513 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200514 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
515 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517chroot <jail dir>
518 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
519 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
520 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
521 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
522 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
523 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100524
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100525cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
526 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
527 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
528 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100529 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
530 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
531 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
532 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
533 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
534 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
535 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
536 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
537 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
538 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100539
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200540crt-base <dir>
541 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
542 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
543 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545daemon
546 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
547 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
548 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
549
550gid <number>
551 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
552 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
553 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100554 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
555 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100557
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558group <group name>
559 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
560 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100561
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200562log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
564 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100565 configured with "log global".
566
567 <address> can be one of:
568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100569 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100570 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
571 port).
572
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100573 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
574 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
575 port).
576
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100577 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
578 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
579 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
580 writeable).
581
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100582 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
583 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
584 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
585 in Bourne shell.
586
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100587 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588
589 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
590 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
591 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
592
593 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200594 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
595 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
596 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
597 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
598 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
599 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200601 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100603log-send-hostname [<string>]
604 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
605 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
606 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
607 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
608 the logs.
609
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000610log-tag <string>
611 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
612 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
613 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
614 running on the same host.
615
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616nbproc <number>
617 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
618 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
619 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
620 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
621 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
622
623pidfile <pidfile>
624 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
625 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
626 starting the process. See also "daemon".
627
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100628stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200629 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
630 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
631 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
632 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
633 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
634 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100635 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200636 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
637 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200638
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100639ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
640 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
641 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300642 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100643 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
644 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
645 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
646 "bind" keyword for more information.
647
648ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
649 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
650 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300651 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100652 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
653 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
654 information.
655
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100656ssl-server-verify [none|required]
657 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
658 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
659 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
660
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200661stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
662 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
663 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
664 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
665 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200666
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200667 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
668 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
669 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200670
671stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
672 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
673 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100674 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200675
676stats maxconn <connections>
677 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
678 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
679
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200680uid <number>
681 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
682 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
683 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
684 one. See also "gid" and "user".
685
686ulimit-n <number>
687 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
688 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
689 option.
690
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100691unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
692 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
693
694 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
695 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
696 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
697 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
698 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
699 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
700 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
701 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
702 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
703 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
704
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705user <user name>
706 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
707 See also "uid" and "group".
708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200709node <name>
710 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
711
712 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
713 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
714 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
715 traffic.
716
717description <text>
718 Add a text that describes the instance.
719
720 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
721 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
722 "<" and ">" characters.
723
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007253.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200726-----------------------
727
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200728max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
729 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
730 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
731 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
732 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
733 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
734 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
735 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
736 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
737
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200738maxconn <number>
739 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
740 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
741 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
742 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
743
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200744maxconnrate <number>
745 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
746 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
747 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
748 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
749 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
750 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
751 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
752 fairness.
753
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100754maxcomprate <number>
755 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300756 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100757 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
758 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
759 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
760 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
761 default value.
762
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100763maxcompcpuusage <number>
764 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
765 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
766 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
767 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
768 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
769 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
770 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
771 process down and from introducing high latencies.
772
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100773maxpipes <number>
774 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
775 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
776 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
777 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
778 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
779 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
780
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200781maxsessrate <number>
782 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
783 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
784 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
785 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
786 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
787 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
788 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
789 fairness.
790
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200791maxsslconn <number>
792 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
793 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
794 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
795 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
796 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
797 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
798 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
799
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200800maxsslrate <number>
801 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
802 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
803 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
804 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
805 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
806 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
807 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
808 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
809 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
810 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
811
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100812maxzlibmem <number>
813 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
814 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
815 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100816 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
817 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
818 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
819
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820noepoll
821 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
822 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100823 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824
825nokqueue
826 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
827 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
828 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
829
830nopoll
831 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
832 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100833 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100834 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200835
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100836nosplice
837 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
838 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
839 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100840 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100841 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
842 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
843 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
844 "option splice-response".
845
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300846nogetaddrinfo
847 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
848 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
849
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200850spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900851 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
852 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
853 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
854 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
855 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
856 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200857
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200858tune.bufsize <number>
859 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
860 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
861 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
862 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
863 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
864 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
865 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
866 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400867 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
868 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
869 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200870
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200871tune.chksize <number>
872 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
873 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
874 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
875 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
876 checks whenever possible.
877
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100878tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
879 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
880 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
881 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
882 this value. The default value is 1.
883
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100884tune.http.cookielen <number>
885 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
886 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
887 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
888 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
889 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
890 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
891 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
892 to change this value.
893
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200894tune.http.maxhdr <number>
895 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
896 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
897 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
898 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
899 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
900 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
901 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
902 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
903 limit too high.
904
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100905tune.idletimer <timeout>
906 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
907 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
908 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
909 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
910 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
911 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
912 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
913 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
914 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
915
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100916tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100917 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
918 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
919 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
920 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
921 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
922 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
923 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
924 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
925 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
926 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100927
928tune.maxpollevents <number>
929 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
930 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
931 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
932 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
933 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
934
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200935tune.maxrewrite <number>
936 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
937 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
938 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
939 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
940 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
941 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
942 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
943 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
944 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
945 bufsize.
946
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200947tune.pipesize <number>
948 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
949 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
950 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
951 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
952 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
953 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
954
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100955tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
956tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
957 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
958 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
959 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
960 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
961 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
962 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
963 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
964
965tune.sndbuf.client <number>
966tune.sndbuf.server <number>
967 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
968 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
969 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
970 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
971 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
972 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
973 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
974 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
975 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
976 notifying haproxy again.
977
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100978tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100979 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
980 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
981 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300982 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100983 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
984 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
985 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
986 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
987 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100988 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
989 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100990
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200991tune.ssl.force-private-cache
992 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
993 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
994 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
995 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
996 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
997 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
998
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100999tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1000 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001001 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001002 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1003 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1004 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1005 being used for too long.
1006
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001007tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1008 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1009 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1010 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1011 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1012 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1013 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1014 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1015 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1016 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1017 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001018 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1019 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001020
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001021tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1022 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1023 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1024 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1025 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1026 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1027 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1028 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1029 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1030
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001031tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1032 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001033 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001034 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1035 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1036 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1037
1038tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1039 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1040 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1041 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1042 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010443.3. Debugging
1045--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001046
1047debug
1048 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1049 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1050 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1051 system startup.
1052
1053quiet
1054 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1055 line argument "-q".
1056
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001057
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010583.4. Userlists
1059--------------
1060It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1061http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1062it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1063
1064userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001065 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001066 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1067
1068group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001069 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001070 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1071 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1072
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001073user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1074 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001075 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1076 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001077 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1078 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001079 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001080 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001081
1082
1083 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001084 userlist L1
1085 group G1 users tiger,scott
1086 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001087
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001088 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1089 user scott insecure-password elgato
1090 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001091
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001092 userlist L2
1093 group G1
1094 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001095
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001096 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1097 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1098 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001099
1100 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001101
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001102
11033.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001104----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001105It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1106haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1107pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1108identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1109or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1110Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1111known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1112the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1113process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1114during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1115tables.
1116
1117peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001118 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001119 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1120
1121peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1122 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1123 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1124 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1125 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1126 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1127 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1128
1129 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1130 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1131
1132 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1133 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1134 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1135 across all peers.
1136
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001137 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1138 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1139 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1140
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001141 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001142 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001143 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1144 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1145 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001146
1147 backend mybackend
1148 mode tcp
1149 balance roundrobin
1150 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1151 stick on src
1152
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001153 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1154 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001155
1156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011574. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001158----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001159
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001160Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1161 - defaults <name>
1162 - frontend <name>
1163 - backend <name>
1164 - listen <name>
1165
1166A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1167its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1168section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001169section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001170
1171A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1172connections.
1173
1174A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1175to forward incoming connections.
1176
1177A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1178parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1179
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001180All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1181'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1182case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1183
1184Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1185logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1186proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1187However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1188name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1189
1190Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1191and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001192bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001193protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1194modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1195arbitrary criteria.
1196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001197In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1198a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1199the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1200
1201 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1202 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1203 between responses and new requests.
1204
1205 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1206 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1208 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1209
1210 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1211 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1212 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1213
1214 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1215 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1216 client-facing connection remains open.
1217
1218 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1219 after the end of the response.
1220
1221The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1222frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1223following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1224weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1225
1226 Backend mode
1227
1228 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1229 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1230 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1231 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1232 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1233 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1234 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1235 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1236 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1237 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1238 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1239
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001240
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012424.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1243--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001245The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1246limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1247they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1248limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001249marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001250option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001251and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1252with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1253specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001254
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001255
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001256 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1257------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1258acl - X X X
1259appsession - - X X
1260backlog X X X -
1261balance X - X X
1262bind - X X -
1263bind-process X X X X
1264block - X X X
1265capture cookie - X X -
1266capture request header - X X -
1267capture response header - X X -
1268clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001269compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001270contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1271cookie X - X X
1272default-server X - X X
1273default_backend X X X -
1274description - X X X
1275disabled X X X X
1276dispatch - - X X
1277enabled X X X X
1278errorfile X X X X
1279errorloc X X X X
1280errorloc302 X X X X
1281-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1282errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001283force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001284fullconn X - X X
1285grace X X X X
1286hash-type X - X X
1287http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001288http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001289http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001290http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001291http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001292http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001293id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001294ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001295log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001296max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001297maxconn X X X -
1298mode X X X X
1299monitor fail - X X -
1300monitor-net X X X -
1301monitor-uri X X X -
1302option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1303option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1304option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1305option allbackups (*) X - X X
1306option checkcache (*) X - X X
1307option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1308option contstats (*) X X X -
1309option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1310option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1311option forceclose (*) X X X X
1312-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1313option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001314option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001315option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001316option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001317option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001318option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001319option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1320option httpchk X - X X
1321option httpclose (*) X X X X
1322option httplog X X X X
1323option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001324option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001325option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001326option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1327option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1328option logasap (*) X X X -
1329option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001330option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001331option nolinger (*) X X X X
1332option originalto X X X X
1333option persist (*) X - X X
1334option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001335option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001336option smtpchk X - X X
1337option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1338option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1339option splice-request (*) X X X X
1340option splice-response (*) X X X X
1341option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1342option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1343-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001344option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001345option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1346option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1347option tcpka X X X X
1348option tcplog X X X X
1349option transparent (*) X - X X
1350persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1351rate-limit sessions X X X -
1352redirect - X X X
1353redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1354redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1355reqadd - X X X
1356reqallow - X X X
1357reqdel - X X X
1358reqdeny - X X X
1359reqiallow - X X X
1360reqidel - X X X
1361reqideny - X X X
1362reqipass - X X X
1363reqirep - X X X
1364reqisetbe - X X X
1365reqitarpit - X X X
1366reqpass - X X X
1367reqrep - X X X
1368-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1369reqsetbe - X X X
1370reqtarpit - X X X
1371retries X - X X
1372rspadd - X X X
1373rspdel - X X X
1374rspdeny - X X X
1375rspidel - X X X
1376rspideny - X X X
1377rspirep - X X X
1378rsprep - X X X
1379server - - X X
1380source X - X X
1381srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001382stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001383stats auth X - X X
1384stats enable X - X X
1385stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001386stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001387stats realm X - X X
1388stats refresh X - X X
1389stats scope X - X X
1390stats show-desc X - X X
1391stats show-legends X - X X
1392stats show-node X - X X
1393stats uri X - X X
1394-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1395stick match - - X X
1396stick on - - X X
1397stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001398stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001399stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001400tcp-check connect - - X X
1401tcp-check expect - - X X
1402tcp-check send - - X X
1403tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001404tcp-request connection - X X -
1405tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001406tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001407tcp-response content - - X X
1408tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001409timeout check X - X X
1410timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001411timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001412timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1413timeout connect X - X X
1414timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1415timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1416timeout http-request X X X X
1417timeout queue X - X X
1418timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001419timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001420timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1421timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001422timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001423transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001424unique-id-format X X X -
1425unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001426use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001427use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001428------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1429 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001430
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001431
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014324.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1433---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001434
1435This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1436
1437
1438acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1439 Declare or complete an access list.
1440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1441 no | yes | yes | yes
1442 Example:
1443 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1444 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1445 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1446
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001447 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001448
1449
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001450appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1451 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001452 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1454 no | no | yes | yes
1455 Arguments :
1456 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1457 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1458
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001459 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001460 checked in each cookie value.
1461
1462 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1463 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1464 milliseconds.
1465
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001466 request-learn
1467 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1468 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1469 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1470 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1471 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1472 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1473
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001474 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1475 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1476 data following this prefix.
1477
1478 Example :
1479 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1480
1481 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1482 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1483
1484 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1485 2 modes are currently supported :
1486 - path-parameters :
1487 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1488 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1489 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1490 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1491 - query-string :
1492 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1493 query string.
1494
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001495 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1496 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1497 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1498 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001499 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1500 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1501 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001502 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1503 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1504
1505 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1506
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001507 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1508 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1509 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1510
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001511 Example :
1512 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1513
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001514 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1515 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001516
1517
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001518backlog <conns>
1519 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1521 yes | yes | yes | no
1522 Arguments :
1523 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1524 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001525 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001526
1527 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1528 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1529 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1530 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1531 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1532 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1533 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1534 backlog parameter.
1535
1536 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1537 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1538 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1539
1540 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1541
1542
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001543balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001544balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001545 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1547 yes | no | yes | yes
1548 Arguments :
1549 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1550 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1551 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1552 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1553
1554 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1555 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1556 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1557 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001558 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001559 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001560 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1561 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1562 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1563 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1564 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1565 it, so that you don't worry.
1566
1567 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1568 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1569 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1570 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1571 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1572 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1573 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1574 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001575
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001576 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1577 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1578 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1579 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1580 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1581 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1582 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1583 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1584
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001585 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001586 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001587 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1588 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001589 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001590 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1591 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1592 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1593 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1594 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001595 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1596 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1597 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1598 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1599 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1600 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001601
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001602 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1603 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1604 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1605 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1606 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1607 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1608 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1609 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001610 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001611 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001612 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1613 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1614 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001616 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1617 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1618 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1619 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1620 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1621 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1622 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1623 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1624 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1625 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1626 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1627 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001628
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001629 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001630 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1631 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1632 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1633 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1634 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1635 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1636 URIs start with a leading "/".
1637
1638 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1639 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1640 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1641 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1642
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001643 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001644 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1645
1646 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001647 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1648 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001649 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1650 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1651 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1652 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001653 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001654 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1655 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001656
1657 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1658 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1659 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1660 server will receive the request.
1661
1662 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1663 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1664 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1665 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1666 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001667 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1668 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1669 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001670
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001671 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1672 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1673 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1674 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1675 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001677 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001678 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1679 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1680 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1681
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001682 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1683 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1684 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1685
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001686 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001687 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001688 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1689 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1690 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1691 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1692 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1693 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001694 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001695 used instead.
1696
1697 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1698 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1699 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1700 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1701
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001702 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1703 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1704 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1705
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001706 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001708 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001709 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1710 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001711
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001712 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1713 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1714 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001715
1716 Examples :
1717 balance roundrobin
1718 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001719 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001720 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1721 balance hdr(host)
1722 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001723
1724 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1725 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001727 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001728 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1729 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1730 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1731 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1732
1733 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1734 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1735 defaults to 16 kB.
1736
1737 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1738 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1739
1740 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1741 Round Robin.
1742
1743 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1744 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1745 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1746 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1747
1748 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1749
1750 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001751 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001752 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1753 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1754 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001755
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001756 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1757 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001758
1759
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001760bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1761bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1764 no | yes | yes | no
1765 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001766 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1767 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1768 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1769 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001770 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001771 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1772 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1773 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1774 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1775 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1776 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1777 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02001778 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001779 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1780 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1781 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001782 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1783 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1784 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1785 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001786
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001787 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1788 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001789 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1790 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1791 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001792 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1793 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1794 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1795 the range.
1796
1797 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1798 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1799 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1800 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1801 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1802 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1803 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001804 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001805 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001806
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001807 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1808 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1809 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1810 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1811 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1812 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1813 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1814 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1815
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001816 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1817 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1818 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1819 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001820
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1822 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1823 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1824 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1825 in a frontend.
1826
1827 Example :
1828 listen http_proxy
1829 bind :80,:443
1830 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001831 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001832
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001833 listen http_https_proxy
1834 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001835 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001836
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001837 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1838 bind ipv6@:80
1839 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1840 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1841
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001842 listen external_bind_app1
1843 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1844
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001845 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001846 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001847
1848
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001849bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001850 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1852 yes | yes | yes | yes
1853 Arguments :
1854 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1855 may be used to override a default value.
1856
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001857 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001858 option may be combined with other numbers.
1859
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001860 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001861 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1862 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1863 missing from all processes.
1864
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001865 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001866 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001867 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1868 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1869 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1870 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001871
1872 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1873 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1874 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1875 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1876 and 'even' instances.
1877
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001878 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1879 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1880 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1881 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001882
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001883 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1884 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1885
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001886 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1887 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1888
1889 Example :
1890 listen app_ip1
1891 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001892 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001893
1894 listen app_ip2
1895 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001896 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001897
1898 listen management
1899 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001900 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001901
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001902 listen management
1903 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1904 bind-process 1-4
1905
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001906 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001907
1908
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001909block { if | unless } <condition>
1910 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1912 no | yes | yes | yes
1913
1914 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1915 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001916 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001917 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001918 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1919 "block" statements per instance.
1920
1921 Example:
1922 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1923 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1924 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1925 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001927 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001928
1929
1930capture cookie <name> len <length>
1931 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1933 no | yes | yes | no
1934 Arguments :
1935 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1936 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1937 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1938 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1939 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1940
1941 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1942 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1943 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1944 right if it exceeds <length>.
1945
1946 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1947 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1948 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1949 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1950
1951 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1952 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1953 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1954
1955 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1956 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1957 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001958 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1959 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1960 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001961
1962 Example:
1963 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1964
1965 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001966 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001967
1968
1969capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001970 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1972 no | yes | yes | no
1973 Arguments :
1974 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001975 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001976 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1977 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1978 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1979
1980 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1981 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1982 it exceeds <length>.
1983
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001984 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001985 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1986 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001987 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1988 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1989 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1990 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001991 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001992 environments to find where the request came from.
1993
1994 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1995 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1996 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1997 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001998
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001999 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2000 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2001 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2002 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2003 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002004
2005 Example:
2006 capture request header Host len 15
2007 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2008 capture request header Referrer len 15
2009
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002010 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011 about logging.
2012
2013
2014capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002015 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2017 no | yes | yes | no
2018 Arguments :
2019 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002020 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002021 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2022 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2023 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2024
2025 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2026 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2027 it exceeds <length>.
2028
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002029 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002030 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2031 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2032 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002033 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2034 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2035 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2036 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002037
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002038 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2039 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2040 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2041 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2042 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002043
2044 Example:
2045 capture response header Content-length len 9
2046 capture response header Location len 15
2047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002048 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002049 about logging.
2050
2051
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002052clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002053 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2055 yes | yes | yes | no
2056 Arguments :
2057 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2058 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2059 as explained at the top of this document.
2060
2061 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2062 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2063 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2064 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2065 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2066 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2067 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2068 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002069 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2071 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2072
2073 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2074 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2075 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2076 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2077 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2078 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2079
2080 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2081 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2082
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002083 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2084 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002085
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002086compression algo <algorithm> ...
2087compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002088compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002089 Enable HTTP compression.
2090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2091 yes | yes | yes | yes
2092 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002093 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2094 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2095 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2096
2097 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002098 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002099 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2100 data.
2101
2102 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2103 support for zlib was built in.
2104
2105 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2106 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2107 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2108 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2109 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2110 in.
2111
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002112 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002113 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002114 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2115 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2116 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2117 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2118 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002119
2120 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2121 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2122 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2123 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2124 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002125 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2126 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2127 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2128 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2129 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2130 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002131
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002132 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002133 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2134 "Accept-Encoding" header
2135 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002136 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002137 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2138 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002139 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2140 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2141 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2142 "multipart"
2143 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2144 header
2145 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2146 and later
2147 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2148 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002149
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002150 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2151 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002152
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002153 Examples :
2154 compression algo gzip
2155 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002156
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002157contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002158 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2160 yes | no | yes | yes
2161 Arguments :
2162 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2163 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2164 as explained at the top of this document.
2165
2166 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002167 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002168 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002169 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2170 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2171 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2172 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2173
2174 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2175 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2176 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2177 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2178 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2179 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2180
2181 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2182 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2183 instead.
2184
2185 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2186 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2187
2188
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002189cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002190 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2191 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002192 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2194 yes | no | yes | yes
2195 Arguments :
2196 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2197 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2198 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2199 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2200 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2201 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2202 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2203 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2204 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2205
2206 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2207 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2208 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2209 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2210 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2211 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2212 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2213 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2214 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2215 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2216 "insert" and "prefix".
2217
2218 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002219 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002220
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002221 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002222 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2223 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2224 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2225 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2226 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2227 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2228 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2229 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2230 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2231 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002232
2233 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2234 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2235 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2236 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2237 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2238 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2239 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2240 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2241 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2242 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002243 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2244 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2245 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002246
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002247 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2248 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2249 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002250 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2251 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2252 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2253 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002254 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2255 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2256 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002257
2258 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2259 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2260 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2261 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2262 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2263 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2264 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2265 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2266 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2267
2268 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2269 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2270 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2271 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2272 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2273 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2274 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2275 persistence cookie in the cache.
2276 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2277
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002278 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2279 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2280 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2281 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2282 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2283 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2284 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2285 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2286 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2287 they logout.
2288
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002289 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2290 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2291 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2292 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2293
2294 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2295 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2296 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2297 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2298 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2299 this attribute.
2300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002301 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002302 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002303 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2304 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2305 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2306 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2307 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2308 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002309
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002310 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2311 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2312 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2313 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2314 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2315 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2316 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2317 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2318 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2319 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2320 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2321 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2322 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2323 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2324 the site.
2325
2326 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2327 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2328 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2329 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2330 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2331 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2332 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2333 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2334 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2335 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2336 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2337 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2338 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2339 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2340 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2341 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2342
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002343 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2344 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2345 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2346 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002348 Examples :
2349 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2350 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2351 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002352 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002353
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002354 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002355 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002356
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002357
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002358default-server [param*]
2359 Change default options for a server in a backend
2360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2361 yes | no | yes | yes
2362 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002363 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2364 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2365 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2366 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002367
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002368 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002369 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2370
2371 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002372
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002374default_backend <backend>
2375 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2377 yes | yes | yes | no
2378 Arguments :
2379 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2380
2381 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2382 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2383 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2384 will catch all undetermined requests.
2385
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002386 Example :
2387
2388 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2389 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2390 default_backend dynamic
2391
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002392 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2393
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002394
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002395description <string>
2396 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2398 no | yes | yes | yes
2399 Arguments : string
2400
2401 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2402 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2403 it describes.
2404 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2405
2406
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002407disabled
2408 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2410 yes | yes | yes | yes
2411 Arguments : none
2412
2413 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2414 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2415 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2416 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2417 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2418 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2419 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2420
2421 See also : "enabled"
2422
2423
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002424dispatch <address>:<port>
2425 Set a default server address
2426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2427 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002428 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002429
2430 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2431 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2432 during start-up.
2433
2434 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2435 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2436 possible with normal servers.
2437
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002438 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002439 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2440 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2441 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2442 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2443
2444 See also : "server"
2445
2446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002447enabled
2448 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2450 yes | yes | yes | yes
2451 Arguments : none
2452
2453 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2454 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2455
2456 See also : "disabled"
2457
2458
2459errorfile <code> <file>
2460 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2462 yes | yes | yes | yes
2463 Arguments :
2464 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002465 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466
2467 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002468 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002469 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002470 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2471 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002472
2473 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2474 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2475 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2476
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002477 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2478
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002479 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2480 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2481 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2482 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2483
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002484 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2485 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2486 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2487 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2488 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2489 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2490
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2492 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2493 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002494 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2496
2497 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2498
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002499 Example :
2500 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002501 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002502 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2503 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2504
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002505
2506errorloc <code> <url>
2507errorloc302 <code> <url>
2508 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2510 yes | yes | yes | yes
2511 Arguments :
2512 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002513 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002514
2515 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2516 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2517 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2518 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2519 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2520
2521 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2522 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2523 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2524
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002525 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2526
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002527 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2528 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2529 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2530 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2531 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2532 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2533 request.
2534
2535 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2536
2537
2538errorloc303 <code> <url>
2539 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2541 yes | yes | yes | yes
2542 Arguments :
2543 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2544 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2545
2546 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2547 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2548 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2549 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2550 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2551
2552 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2553 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2554 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2555
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002556 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2557
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002558 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2559 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2560 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2561 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002562 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002563
2564 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2565
2566
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002567force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2568 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2569 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2570 no | yes | yes | yes
2571
2572 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2573 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2574 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2575 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2576 marked down for maintenance operations.
2577
2578 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2579 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2580 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2581 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2582 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2583 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2584 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2585 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2586 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2587
2588 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2589 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2590 is used.
2591
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002592 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002593 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002594
2595
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002596fullconn <conns>
2597 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2599 yes | no | yes | yes
2600 Arguments :
2601 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2602 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2603
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002604 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002605 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002606 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002607 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2608 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2609 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2610 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2611 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002612 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002613
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002614 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2615 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002616 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2617 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2618 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002619
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002620 Example :
2621 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2622 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2623 # connections.
2624 backend dynamic
2625 fullconn 10000
2626 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2627 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2628
2629 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2630
2631
2632grace <time>
2633 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002635 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002636 Arguments :
2637 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2638 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2639 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2640
2641 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2642 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002643 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002644 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2645
2646 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2647 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2648 simplify it.
2649
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002650
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002651hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002652 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2654 yes | no | yes | yes
2655 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002656 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2657 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002658
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002659 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2660 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2661 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2662 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2663 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2664 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2665 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2666 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2667 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2668 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002669
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002670 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2671 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2672 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2673 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2674 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2675 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2676 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2677 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2678 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2679 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2680 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2681 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2682 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002683 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2684 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002685
2686 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2687
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002688 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002689 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2690 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2691 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002692 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2693 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2694 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002695
2696 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2697 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002698 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2699 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2700 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2701 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2702
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002703 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2704 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2705 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2706 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2707 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2708 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2709 parameter.
2710
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002711 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2712
2713 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2714 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2715 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2716 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2717 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2718 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2719 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2720 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2721 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2722 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2723 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2724 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002725
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002726 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2727 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2728 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002729
2730 See also : "balance", "server"
2731
2732
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002733http-check disable-on-404
2734 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002736 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002737 Arguments : none
2738
2739 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2740 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2741 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2742 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2743 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2744 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2745 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2746 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002747 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2748 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2749 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2750
2751 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2752
2753
2754http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002755 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002757 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002758 Arguments :
2759 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2760 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002761 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002762 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2763 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2764 details on the supported keywords.
2765
2766 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2767 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2768 with the usual backslash ('\').
2769
2770 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2771 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2772 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2773 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2774 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2775
2776 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002777 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002778 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2779 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2780 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2781
2782 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002783 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002784 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2785 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2786 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2787 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2788
2789 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002790 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002791 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2792 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2793 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2794 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2795 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2796 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2797 trace).
2798
2799 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002800 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002801 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2802 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2803 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2804 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2805 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2806 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2807
2808 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2809 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2810 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2811 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2812 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2813 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2814 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2815 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2816
2817 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2818 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2819
2820 Examples :
2821 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002822 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002823
2824 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002825 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002826
2827 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002828 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002829
2830 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002831 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002832
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002833 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002834
2835
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002836http-check send-state
2837 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2839 yes | no | yes | yes
2840 Arguments : none
2841
2842 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2843 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2844 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2845 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2846 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2847
2848 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2849 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2850 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2851 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2852 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2853 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2854 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2855 checked in multiple backends.
2856
2857 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2858 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2859
2860 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2861 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2862 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2863 one fails.
2864
2865 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2866 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2867 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2868
2869 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2870 server's queue.
2871
2872 Example of a header received by the application server :
2873 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2874 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2875
2876 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2877
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002878http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002879 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002880 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002881 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2882 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2883 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2884 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2885 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2886 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002887 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002888 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2889
2890 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2891 no | yes | yes | yes
2892
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002893 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2894 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2895 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2896 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2897 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002898
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002899 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2900 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2901 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2902
2903 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2904 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2905 are evaluated.
2906
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002907 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2908 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2909 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2910 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2911 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2912 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2913 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2914 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2915 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002916 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002917 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2918
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002919 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2920 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2921 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2922 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2923 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2924
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002925 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2926 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2927 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002928 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2929 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002930
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002931 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2932 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2933 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2934 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2935 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2936 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2937 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2938 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2939
2940 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2941 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2942 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2943 external users.
2944
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002945 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2946 <name>.
2947
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002948 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2949 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2950 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2951 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2952 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2953 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2954 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2955 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2956
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002957 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2958 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2959 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2960 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2961 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2962 another equipment.
2963
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002964 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2965 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2966 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2967 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2968 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2969 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2970 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2971 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2972
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002973 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2974 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2975 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2976 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2977 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2978 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2979 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2980 admin privileges.
2981
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002982 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2983 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2984 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2985 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
2986 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
2987 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
2988 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
2989 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2990
2991 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2992 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2993 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2994 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
2995 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
2996 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2997
2998 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
2999 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3000 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3001 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3002 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3003 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3004
3005 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3006 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3007 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3008 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3009 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3010 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3011 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3012 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3013 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3014
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003015 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3016
3017 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3018 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3019 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3020 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003021
3022 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003023 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3024 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3025 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003026
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003027 http-request allow if nagios
3028 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3029 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3030 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003031
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003032 Example:
3033 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003034 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003035
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003036 Example:
3037 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3038 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3039 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3040 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3041 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3042 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3043 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3044 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3045 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3046
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003047 Example:
3048 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3049 acl add path /addacl
3050 acl del path /delacl
3051
3052 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3053
3054 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3055 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3056
3057 Example:
3058 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3059 acl setmap path /setmap
3060 acl delmap path /delmap
3061
3062 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3063
3064 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3065 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3066
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003067 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3068 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003069
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003070http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003071 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003072 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3073 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3074 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3075 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3076 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3077 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003078 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003079 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3080
3081 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3082 no | yes | yes | yes
3083
3084 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3085 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3086 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3087 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3088 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3089 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3090
3091 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3092 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3093 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3094 current section.
3095
3096 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3097 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3098 rules are evaluated.
3099
3100 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3101 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3102 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3103 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3104 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3105 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3106 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3107
3108 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3109 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3110 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3111 external users.
3112
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003113 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3114 <name>.
3115
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003116 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3117 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3118 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3119 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3120 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3121 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3122 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3123 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3124
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003125 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3126 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3127 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3128 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3129 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3130 another equipment.
3131
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003132 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3133 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3134 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3135 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3136 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3137 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3138 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3139 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3140
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003141 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3142 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3143 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3144 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3145 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3146 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3147 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3148 admin privileges.
3149
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003150 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3151 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3152 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3153 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3154 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3155 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3156 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3157 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3158
3159 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3160 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3161 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3162 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3163 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3164 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3165
3166 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3167 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3168 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3169 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3170 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3171 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3172
3173 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3174 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3175 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3176 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3177 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3178 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3179 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3180 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3181 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3182
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003183 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3184
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003185 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003186 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3187 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3188 rules.
3189
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003190 Example:
3191 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3192
3193 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3194
3195 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3196 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3197
3198 Example:
3199 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3200
3201 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3202
3203 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3204 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3205
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003206 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3207 ACL usage.
3208
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003209
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003210http-send-name-header [<header>]
3211 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3212
3213 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3214 yes | no | yes | yes
3215
3216 Arguments :
3217
3218 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3219
3220 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3221 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3222 is added with the header string proved.
3223
3224 See also : "server"
3225
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003226id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003227 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3229 no | yes | yes | yes
3230 Arguments : none
3231
3232 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3233 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3234 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003235
3236
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003237ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3238 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3239 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3240 no | yes | yes | yes
3241
3242 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3243 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3244 and running).
3245
3246 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3247 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3248 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003249 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003250 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3251
3252 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3253 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3254
3255 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3256 "unless" condition is met.
3257
3258 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3259
3260
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003261log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003262log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003263no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003264 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3266 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003267
3268 Prefix :
3269 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3270 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3271 prefix does not allow arguments.
3272
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003273 Arguments :
3274 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3275 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3276 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3277 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3278 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3279 parameter.
3280
3281 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3282 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3283
3284 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3285 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3286 standard syslog port).
3287
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003288 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3289 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3290 standard syslog port).
3291
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003292 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3293 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3294 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3295 appropriately writeable).
3296
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003297 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3298 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3299 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3300 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3301
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003302 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3303
3304 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3305 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3306 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3307
3308 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3309 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3310 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003311 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3312 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3313 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3314 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3315 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003316
3317 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3318
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003319 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3320 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3321 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003322
3323 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3324 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3325 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3326 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3327
3328 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3329 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003330
3331 Example :
3332 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003333 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3334 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003335 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3336
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003337
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003338log-format <string>
3339 Allows you to custom a log line.
3340
3341 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3342
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003343
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003344max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3345 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3346 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3347 yes | no | yes | yes
3348
3349 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3350 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3351 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3352 servers.
3353
3354 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3355 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3356 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3357 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3358 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3359 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3360 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3361 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3362 picking a different server.
3363
3364 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3365 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3366 even if they have to be queued.
3367
3368 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3369 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3370
3371
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003372maxconn <conns>
3373 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3375 yes | yes | yes | no
3376 Arguments :
3377 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3378 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3379 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3380 closes.
3381
3382 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3383 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3384 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3385 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3386 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3387 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3388 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3389 properly tuned.
3390
3391 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3392 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3393 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3394
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003395 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3396
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003397 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3398
3399
3400mode { tcp|http|health }
3401 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3403 yes | yes | yes | yes
3404 Arguments :
3405 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3406 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3407 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3408 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3409
3410 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3411 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3412 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3413 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3414 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3415
3416 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003417 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3418 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3419 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3420 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3421 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3422 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3423 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003424
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003425 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3426 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3427 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003428
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003429 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003430 defaults http_instances
3431 mode http
3432
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003433 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003434
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003435
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003436monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003437 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3439 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003440 Arguments :
3441 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3442 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003443 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003444 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3445 backend and its backup.
3446
3447 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3448 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3449 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3450 servers in a list of backends.
3451
3452 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3453 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3454 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3455 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3456 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3457 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3458 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003459 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3460 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003461
3462 Example:
3463 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003464 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3466 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3467 monitor-uri /site_alive
3468 monitor fail if site_dead
3469
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003470 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003471
3472
3473monitor-net <source>
3474 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3476 yes | yes | yes | no
3477 Arguments :
3478 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3479 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3480 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3481 followed by a mask.
3482
3483 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3484 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003485 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003486 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3487
3488 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3489 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3490 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3491 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003492 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3493 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3494 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003495
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003496 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3497 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3498 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3499 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3500 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3501 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003502
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003503 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3504 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003505
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003506 Example :
3507 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3508 frontend www
3509 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3510
3511 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3512
3513
3514monitor-uri <uri>
3515 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3517 yes | yes | yes | no
3518 Arguments :
3519 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3520 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3521
3522 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3523 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3524 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3525 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3526 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3527 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3528 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3529 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3530
3531 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3532 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3533 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3534 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3535 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3536 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3537
3538 Example :
3539 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3540 frontend www
3541 mode http
3542 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3543
3544 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3545
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003546
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003547option abortonclose
3548no option abortonclose
3549 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3551 yes | no | yes | yes
3552 Arguments : none
3553
3554 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3555 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3556 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3557 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003558 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003559 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3560 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3561 encountered while delivering the response.
3562
3563 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3564 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3565 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3566 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3567 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3568 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003569 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003570 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003571 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003572 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3573 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3574 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3575
3576 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3577 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3578 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3579 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3580 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3581 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3582 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3583 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003584 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003585
3586 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3587 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3588
3589 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3590
3591
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003592option accept-invalid-http-request
3593no option accept-invalid-http-request
3594 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3596 yes | yes | yes | no
3597 Arguments : none
3598
3599 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3600 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3601 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3602 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3603 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3604 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3605 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3606 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003607 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3608 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3609 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3610 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3611 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3612 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003613
3614 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3615 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3616 been confirmed.
3617
3618 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3619 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003620 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3621 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003622 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3623
3624 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3625 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3626
3627 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3628 stats socket.
3629
3630
3631option accept-invalid-http-response
3632no option accept-invalid-http-response
3633 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3635 yes | no | yes | yes
3636 Arguments : none
3637
3638 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3639 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3640 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3641 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3642 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3643 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3644 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3645 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3646 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3647
3648 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3649 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3650 been confirmed.
3651
3652 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3653 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3654 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3655 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3656
3657 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3658 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3659
3660 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3661 stats socket.
3662
3663
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003664option allbackups
3665no option allbackups
3666 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3668 yes | no | yes | yes
3669 Arguments : none
3670
3671 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3672 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3673 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3674 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3675 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3676 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3677 order between the backup servers anymore.
3678
3679 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3680 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3681
3682 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3683 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3684
3685
3686option checkcache
3687no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003688 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3690 yes | no | yes | yes
3691 Arguments : none
3692
3693 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3694 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003695 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003696 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3697 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003698 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003699
3700 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003701 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003702 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003703 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3704 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003705 to the client are :
3706 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003707 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003708 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003709 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3710 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3711 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3712 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3713 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3714 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3715 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3716 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3717 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3718 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3719 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3720
3721 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003722 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003723 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003724 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003725 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3726
3727 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3728 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003729 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003730 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3731
3732 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3733 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3734
3735
3736option clitcpka
3737no option clitcpka
3738 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3740 yes | yes | yes | no
3741 Arguments : none
3742
3743 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3744 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3745 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3746 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3747
3748 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3749 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3750 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3751 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3752
3753 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3754 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3755 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3756 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3757 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3758
3759 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3760
3761 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3762 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3763 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3764
3765 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3766 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3767
3768 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3769
3770
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003771option contstats
3772 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3774 yes | yes | yes | no
3775 Arguments : none
3776
3777 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3778 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3779 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3780 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3781 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3782 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3783 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3784
3785
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003786option dontlog-normal
3787no option dontlog-normal
3788 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3790 yes | yes | yes | no
3791 Arguments : none
3792
3793 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3794 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3795 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3796 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3797 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3798 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3799 logged.
3800
3801 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3802 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3803 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003805 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003806 logging.
3807
3808
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003809option dontlognull
3810no option dontlognull
3811 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3813 yes | yes | yes | no
3814 Arguments : none
3815
3816 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3817 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3818 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3819 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3820 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3821 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3822 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3823
3824 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3825 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3826 would not be logged.
3827
3828 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3829 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003831 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003832
3833
3834option forceclose
3835no option forceclose
3836 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003838 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003839 Arguments : none
3840
3841 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3842 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3843 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3844 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3845 global session times in the logs.
3846
3847 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003848 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003849 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003850
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003851 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3852 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3853 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3854
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003855 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3856 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003857
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003858 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3859 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3860
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003861 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003862
3863
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003864option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003865 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3867 yes | yes | yes | yes
3868 Arguments :
3869 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3870 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003871 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003872 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003873
3874 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3875 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3876 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3877 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3878 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3879 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3880 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003881 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3882 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3883 possible that the client has already brought one.
3884
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003885 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003886 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003887 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3888 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003889 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3890 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003891
3892 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3893 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3894 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3895 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3896 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3897 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3898 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3899
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003900 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3901 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3902 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3903 are under the control of the end-user.
3904
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003905 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003906 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3907 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003908 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3909 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3910 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003911
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003912 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003913 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3914 frontend www
3915 mode http
3916 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3917
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003918 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3919 backend www
3920 mode http
3921 option forwardfor header X-Client
3922
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003923 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003924 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003925
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003926
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003927option http-keep-alive
3928no option http-keep-alive
3929 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3931 yes | yes | yes | yes
3932 Arguments : none
3933
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003934 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3935 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3936 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
3937 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
3938 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3939 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
3940 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
3941
3942 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
3943 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003944 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3945 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3946 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3947 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3948 situations where this option may be useful :
3949
3950 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3951 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3952
3953 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3954 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3955
3956 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3957 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3958 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3959 request.
3960
3961 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3962 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003963 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3964 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3965 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003966
3967 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3968 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3969
3970 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3971 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3972 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3973 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3974 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3975 not set.
3976
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003977 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3978 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003979 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003980 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003981
3982 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003983 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3984 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003985
3986
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003987option http-no-delay
3988no option http-no-delay
3989 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3991 yes | yes | yes | yes
3992 Arguments : none
3993
3994 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3995 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3996 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3997 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3998 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3999 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4000 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4001 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4002 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4003 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4004 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4005 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4006 affected.
4007
4008 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4009 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4010 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4011 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4012 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4013 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4014 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4015 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4016 latency environments.
4017
4018
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004019option http-pretend-keepalive
4020no option http-pretend-keepalive
4021 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4023 yes | yes | yes | yes
4024 Arguments : none
4025
4026 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4027 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4028 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4029 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4030 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4031 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4032 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4033 consider the response complete.
4034
4035 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4036 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4037 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4038 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4039 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4040 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4041
4042 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4043 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4044 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4045 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4046 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4047 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4048 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4049
4050 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4051 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004052 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004053 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4054 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004055
4056 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4057 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4058
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004059 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4060 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004061
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004062
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004063option http-server-close
4064no option http-server-close
4065 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4067 yes | yes | yes | yes
4068 Arguments : none
4069
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004070 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4071 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4072 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4073 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4074 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4075 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4076 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4077 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4078 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4079 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4080 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4081 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4082 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4083 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4084 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4085 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004086
4087 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4088 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4089 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4090 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004091 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4092 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004093
4094 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4095 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004096 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4097 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004098 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4099 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004100
4101 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4102 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4103
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004104 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004105 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4106 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004107
4108
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004109option http-tunnel
4110no option http-tunnel
4111 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4113 yes | yes | yes | yes
4114 Arguments : none
4115
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004116 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4117 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4118 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4119 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4120 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4121 "option http-tunnel".
4122
4123 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004124 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004125 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4126 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4127 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4128 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4129 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4130 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4131 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004132
4133 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4134 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4135
4136 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4137 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4138 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4139
4140
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004141option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004142no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004143 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4145 yes | yes | yes | no
4146 Arguments : none
4147
4148 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4149 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4150 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4151 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4152 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4153 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4154 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4155
4156 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4157 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4158 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4159 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4160 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4161 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4162 request along its whole life.
4163
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004164 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4165 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4166 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4167 front of an existing proxy.
4168
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004169 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4170
4171 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4172 http-server-close".
4173
4174
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004175option httpchk
4176option httpchk <uri>
4177option httpchk <method> <uri>
4178option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4179 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4181 yes | no | yes | yes
4182 Arguments :
4183 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4184 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4185 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4186 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4187 ones.
4188
4189 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4190 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4191 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4192
4193 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4194 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4195 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4196 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4197 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4198
4199 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4200 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4201 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4202 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4203 the lack of any response.
4204
4205 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4206
4207 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4208 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4209 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4210
4211 Examples :
4212 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4213 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4214 backend https_relay
4215 mode tcp
4216 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4217 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4218
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004219 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4220 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4221 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004222
4223
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004224option httpclose
4225no option httpclose
4226 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4228 yes | yes | yes | yes
4229 Arguments : none
4230
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004231 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4232 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4233 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4234 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004235 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004236 "option http-tunnel".
4237
4238 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4239 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4240 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4241 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4242 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4243 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4244 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4245 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004246
4247 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004248 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004249 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4250 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4251 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4252 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4253 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004254
4255 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4256 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004257 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4258 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004259 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4260 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004261
4262 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4263 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4264
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004265 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4266 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004267
4268
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004269option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004270 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4272 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004273 Arguments :
4274 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4275 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4276 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4277 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4278 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004279
4280 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4281 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4282 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4283 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4284 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4285 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4286 ports.
4287
4288 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4289
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004290 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4291 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4292 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4293 by default.
4294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004295 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004296
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004297
4298option http_proxy
4299no option http_proxy
4300 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4302 yes | yes | yes | yes
4303 Arguments : none
4304
4305 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4306 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4307 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4308 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4309 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4310
4311 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4312 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4313 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4314 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004315 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004316 be analyzed.
4317
4318 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4319 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4320
4321 Example :
4322 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4323 backend direct_forward
4324 option httpclose
4325 option http_proxy
4326
4327 See also : "option httpclose"
4328
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004329
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004330option independent-streams
4331no option independent-streams
4332 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4334 yes | yes | yes | yes
4335 Arguments : none
4336
4337 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4338 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4339 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4340 receive data or not.
4341
4342 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4343 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4344 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4345 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4346 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4347 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4348 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4349 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4350 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4351 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4352 socket buffers.
4353
4354 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4355 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4356 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4357 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4358 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4359
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004360 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004361 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4362 deprecated.
4363
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004364 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004365
4366
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004367option ldap-check
4368 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4370 yes | no | yes | yes
4371 Arguments : none
4372
4373 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4374 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4375 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4376 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4377
4378 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4379 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4380
4381 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4382 configure it.
4383
4384 Example :
4385 option ldap-check
4386
4387 See also : "option httpchk"
4388
4389
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004390option log-health-checks
4391no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004392 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4394 yes | no | yes | yes
4395 Arguments : none
4396
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004397 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4398 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4399 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004400
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004401 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4402 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4403 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4404 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4405 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4406
4407 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4408 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004409
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004410 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4411 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4412 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004413
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004414
4415option log-separate-errors
4416no option log-separate-errors
4417 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4419 yes | yes | yes | no
4420 Arguments : none
4421
4422 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4423 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4424 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4425 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4426 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4427 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4428 provides very important information.
4429
4430 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4431 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4432 error logs.
4433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004434 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004435 logging.
4436
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004437
4438option logasap
4439no option logasap
4440 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4442 yes | yes | yes | no
4443 Arguments : none
4444
4445 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4446 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4447 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4448 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4449 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4450 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4451 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004452 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004453 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4454 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4455
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004456 Examples :
4457 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4458 mode http
4459 option httplog
4460 option logasap
4461 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4462
4463 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4464 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4465 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4466 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004468 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004469 logging.
4470
4471
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004472option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004473 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4475 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004476 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004477 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4478 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004479 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004480
4481 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4482 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4483 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4484 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4485 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4486 in the MySQL table, like this :
4487
4488 USE mysql;
4489 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4490 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4491
4492 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4493 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4494 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4495 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4496 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4497 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4498 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4499 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4500 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4501
4502 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4503 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004504
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004505 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004506
4507 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4508 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4509 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4510 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4511 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4512 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4513
4514 See also: "option httpchk"
4515
4516
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004517option nolinger
4518no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004519 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004520 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4521 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004522 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004523
4524 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4525 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4526 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4527 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4528 connections.
4529
4530 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4531 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4532 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4533 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4534 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4535 this too.
4536
4537 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4538 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4539 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4540
4541 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4542 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4543 for servers.
4544
4545 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4546 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4547
4548
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004549option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4550 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4552 yes | yes | yes | yes
4553 Arguments :
4554 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4555 matching <network>
4556 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4557 header name.
4558
4559 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4560 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4561 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4562 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4563 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4564 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4565 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4566 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4567 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4568 possible that the client has already brought one.
4569
4570 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4571 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4572 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4573 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4574 header and requires different one.
4575
4576 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4577 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4578 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4579 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4580 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4581 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4582 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4583
4584 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4585 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4586 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4587 both are defined.
4588
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004589 Examples :
4590 # Original Destination address
4591 frontend www
4592 mode http
4593 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4594
4595 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4596 backend www
4597 mode http
4598 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4599
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004600 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4601 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004602
4603
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004604option persist
4605no option persist
4606 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4607 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004609 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004610
4611 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4612 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4613 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4614 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4615 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4616 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4617 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4618 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4619 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4620 redirected to another valid server.
4621
4622 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4623 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4624
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004625 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004626
4627
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004628option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4629 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4631 yes | no | yes | yes
4632 Arguments :
4633 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4634 PostgreSQL server.
4635
4636 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4637 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4638 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4639 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4640
4641 See also: "option httpchk"
4642
4643
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004644option prefer-last-server
4645no option prefer-last-server
4646 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4648 yes | no | yes | yes
4649 Arguments : none
4650
4651 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4652 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4653 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4654 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4655 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4656 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4657 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4658 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4659 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004660 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4661 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4662 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4663 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4664 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4665 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4666 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004667
4668 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4669 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4670
4671 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4672
4673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004674option redispatch
4675no option redispatch
4676 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4677 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4678 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004679 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004680
4681 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4682 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4683 be able to access the service anymore.
4684
4685 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4686 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4687
4688 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4689 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4690 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004691
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004692 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4693 "redisp" keywords.
4694
4695 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4696 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4697
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004698 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004699
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004700
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004701option redis-check
4702 Use redis health checks for server testing
4703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4704 yes | no | yes | yes
4705 Arguments : none
4706
4707 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4708 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4709 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4710 find the "+PONG" response message.
4711
4712 Example :
4713 option redis-check
4714
4715 See also : "option httpchk"
4716
4717
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004718option smtpchk
4719option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4720 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4722 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004723 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004724 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4725 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4726 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4727
4728 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4729 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4730 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4731
4732 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4733 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4734 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4735 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4736 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4737 dead server.
4738
4739 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4740 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4741 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4742 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4743
4744 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4745 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4746 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4747 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4748 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4749
4750 Example :
4751 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4752
4753 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004755
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004756option socket-stats
4757no option socket-stats
4758
4759 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4761 yes | yes | yes | no
4762
4763 Arguments : none
4764
4765
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004766option splice-auto
4767no option splice-auto
4768 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4770 yes | yes | yes | yes
4771 Arguments : none
4772
4773 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4774 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4775 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4776 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004777 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004778 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4779 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4780 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4781 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4782
4783 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4784 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4785 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4786 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4787 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4788 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4789 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4790 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4791 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4792 keyword.
4793
4794 Example :
4795 option splice-auto
4796
4797 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4798 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4799
4800 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4801 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4802
4803
4804option splice-request
4805no option splice-request
4806 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4808 yes | yes | yes | yes
4809 Arguments : none
4810
4811 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004812 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004813 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4814 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4815 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4816 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4817
4818 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4819
4820 Example :
4821 option splice-request
4822
4823 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4824 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4825
4826 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4827 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4828
4829
4830option splice-response
4831no option splice-response
4832 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4834 yes | yes | yes | yes
4835 Arguments : none
4836
4837 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004838 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004839 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4840 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4841 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4842 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4843
4844 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4845
4846 Example :
4847 option splice-response
4848
4849 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4850 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4851
4852 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4853 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4854
4855
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004856option srvtcpka
4857no option srvtcpka
4858 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4860 yes | no | yes | yes
4861 Arguments : none
4862
4863 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4864 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4865 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4866 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4867
4868 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4869 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4870 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4871 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4872
4873 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4874 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4875 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4876 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4877 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4878
4879 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4880
4881 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4882 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4883 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4884
4885 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4886 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4887
4888 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4889
4890
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004891option ssl-hello-chk
4892 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4894 yes | no | yes | yes
4895 Arguments : none
4896
4897 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4898 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4899 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4900 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4901 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4902 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4903 hello message.
4904
4905 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4906 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4907 messages, which is appreciable.
4908
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004909 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4910 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4911 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004912
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004913 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4914
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004915
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004916option tcp-check
4917 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4918 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4919 yes | no | yes | yes
4920
4921 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4922 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4923
4924 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4925 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4926 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4927
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004928 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004929 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4930 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4931 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4932 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4933 only.
4934
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004935 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004936 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4937 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4938 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4939 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4940
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004941 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004942 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4943 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004944 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004945 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4946 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4947 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4948 the respective protocols.
4949 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4950 analysed.
4951
4952 Examples :
4953 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4954 option tcp-check
4955 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4956
4957 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4958 option tcp-check
4959 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4960
4961 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4962 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004963 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004964 option tcp-check
4965 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4966 tcp-check expect +PONG
4967 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4968 tcp-check expect string role:master
4969 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4970 tcp-check expect string +OK
4971
4972 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4973 (send many headers before analyzing)
4974 option tcp-check
4975 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4976 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4977 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4978 tcp-check send \r\n
4979 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4980
4981
4982 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4983
4984
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004985option tcp-smart-accept
4986no option tcp-smart-accept
4987 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4989 yes | yes | yes | no
4990 Arguments : none
4991
4992 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4993 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4994 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4995 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4996 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4997 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4998
4999 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5000 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5001 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5002 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5003
5004 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5005 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5006 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5007 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5008
5009 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5010 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5011 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5012
5013 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5014 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5015 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5016
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005017 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5018
5019
5020option tcp-smart-connect
5021no option tcp-smart-connect
5022 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5024 yes | no | yes | yes
5025 Arguments : none
5026
5027 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5028 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5029 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5030 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5031 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5032
5033 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5034 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5035 complex.
5036
5037 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5038 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5039 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5040
5041 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5042 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5043
5044 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5045
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005046
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005047option tcpka
5048 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5050 yes | yes | yes | yes
5051 Arguments : none
5052
5053 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5054 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5055 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5056 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5057
5058 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5059 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5060 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5061 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5062
5063 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5064 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5065 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5066 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5067 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5068
5069 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5070
5071 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5072 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5073 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5074 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5075 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5076 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5077 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5078 backends.
5079
5080 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5081
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005082
5083option tcplog
5084 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5086 yes | yes | yes | yes
5087 Arguments : none
5088
5089 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5090 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5091 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5092 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5093 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5094 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5095 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5096 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5097
5098 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005100 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005101
5102
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005103option transparent
5104no option transparent
5105 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005107 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005108 Arguments : none
5109
5110 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5111 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5112 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5113 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5114 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5115 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5116 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5117 appropriate server.
5118
5119 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5120 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5121
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005122 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005123 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005124
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005125
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005126persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005127persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005128 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5130 yes | no | yes | yes
5131 Arguments :
5132 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005133 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5134 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005135
5136 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5137 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5138 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5139 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5140 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5141 forwarded to this server.
5142
5143 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5144 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5145 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005146 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005147 a single "listen" section.
5148
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005149 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5150 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5151 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5152
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005153 Example :
5154 listen tse-farm
5155 bind :3389
5156 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5157 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5158 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5159 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5160 persist rdp-cookie
5161 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005162 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005163 balance rdp-cookie
5164 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5165 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5166
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005167 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5168 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005169
5170
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005171rate-limit sessions <rate>
5172 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5174 yes | yes | yes | no
5175 Arguments :
5176 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5177 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5178
5179 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5180 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5181 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5182 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5183 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5184 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5185
5186 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5187 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5188 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5189 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5190
5191 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5192 listen smtp
5193 mode tcp
5194 bind :25
5195 rate-limit sessions 10
5196 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5197
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005198 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5199 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5200 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005201
5202 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5203
5204
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005205redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5206redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5207redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005208 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5210 no | yes | yes | yes
5211
5212 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005213 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005214
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005215 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005216 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005217 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5218 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5219 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005220
5221 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5222 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5223 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5224 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5225 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005226 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5227 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5228 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5229 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005230
5231 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5232 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5233 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5234 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5235 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5236 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005237 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005238 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005239 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5240 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5241 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005242
5243 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005244 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5245 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5246 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5247 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5248 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5249 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5250 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5251 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005252
5253 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5254 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5255
5256 - "drop-query"
5257 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5258 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5259 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5260 with a location-type redirect.
5261
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005262 - "append-slash"
5263 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5264 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5265 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5266 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5267
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005268 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5269 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5270 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5271 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5272 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5273 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5274 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5275
5276 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5277 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5278 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5279 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5280 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5281 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5282 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005283
5284 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5285 acl clear dst_port 80
5286 acl secure dst_port 8080
5287 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005288 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005289 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005290 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5291
5292 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005293 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5294 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5295 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005296 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005297
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005298 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5299 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5300 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5301
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005302 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005303 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005304
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005305 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5306 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5307 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005309 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005310
5311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005312redisp (deprecated)
5313redispatch (deprecated)
5314 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5315 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5316 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005317 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005318
5319 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5320 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5321 be able to access the service anymore.
5322
5323 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5324 redistribute them to a working server.
5325
5326 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5327 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5328 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005329
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005330 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5331 "option redispatch" instead.
5332
5333 See also : "option redispatch"
5334
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005335
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005336reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005337 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5339 no | yes | yes | yes
5340 Arguments :
5341 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5342 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005343 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005344
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005345 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5346 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5347
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005348 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5349 the last header of an HTTP request.
5350
5351 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5352 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5353 responses.
5354
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005355 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5356 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5357 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5358
5359 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5360 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005361
5362
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005363reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5364reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005365 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5367 no | yes | yes | yes
5368 Arguments :
5369 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5370 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5371 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5372 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5373 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5374 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5375 ignores case.
5376
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005377 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5378 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5379
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005380 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5381 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5382 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5383 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005384 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005385
5386 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5387 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5388
5389 Example :
5390 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5391 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5392 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5393
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005394 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5395 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005396
5397
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005398reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5399reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005400 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5402 no | yes | yes | yes
5403 Arguments :
5404 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5405 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5406 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5407 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5408 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5409 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5410
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005411 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5412 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5413
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005414 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5415 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5416 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5417 next servers.
5418
5419 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5420 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5421 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5422
5423 Example :
5424 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5425 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5426 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5427
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005428 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5429 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005430
5431
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005432reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5433reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005434 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5436 no | yes | yes | yes
5437 Arguments :
5438 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5439 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5440 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5441 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5442 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5443 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5444 case.
5445
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005446 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5447 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5448
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005449 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5450 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5451 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5452 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005453 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005454
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005455 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005456 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005457 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005458
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005459 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5460 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5461
5462 Example :
5463 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5464 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5465 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5466
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005467 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5468 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005469
5470
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005471reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5472reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005473 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5475 no | yes | yes | yes
5476 Arguments :
5477 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5478 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5479 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5480 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5481 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5482 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5483 case.
5484
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005485 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5486 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5487
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005488 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5489 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5490 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5491 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5492
5493 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5494 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5495
5496 Example :
5497 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5498 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5499 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5500 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5501
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005502 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5503 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005504
5505
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005506reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5507reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005508 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5510 no | yes | yes | yes
5511 Arguments :
5512 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5513 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5514 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5515 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5516 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5517 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5518
5519 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5520 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5521 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5522 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005523 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005524
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005525 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5526 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5527
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005528 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5529 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5530 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5531
5532 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5533 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5534 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5535 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5536 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5537
5538 Example :
5539 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005540 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005541 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5542 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5543
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005544 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5545 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005546
5547
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005548reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5549reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005550 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5552 no | yes | yes | yes
5553 Arguments :
5554 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5555 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5556 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5557 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5558 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5559 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5560 ignores case.
5561
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005562 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5563 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5564
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005565 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5566 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005567 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5568 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5569 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005570 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5571 not set.
5572
5573 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5574 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5575 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5576 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5577 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5578
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005579 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005580 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5581 # block all others.
5582 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5583 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5584
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005585 # block bad guys
5586 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5587 reqitarpit . if badguys
5588
5589 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5590 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005591
5592
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005593retries <value>
5594 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5595 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5596 yes | no | yes | yes
5597 Arguments :
5598 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5599 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5600 default value is 3.
5601
5602 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5603 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5604 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5605
5606 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5607 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5608
5609 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5610 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5611
5612 See also : "option redispatch"
5613
5614
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005615rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005616 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5618 no | yes | yes | yes
5619 Arguments :
5620 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5621 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005622 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005623
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005624 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5625 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5626
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005627 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5628 the last header of an HTTP response.
5629
5630 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5631 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5632 responses.
5633
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005634 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5635 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005636
5637
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005638rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5639rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005640 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5642 no | yes | yes | yes
5643 Arguments :
5644 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5645 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5646 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5647 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5648 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5649 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5650 ignores case.
5651
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005652 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5653 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5654
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005655 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5656 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005657 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005658 client.
5659
5660 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5661 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5662 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5663
5664 Example :
5665 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005666 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005667
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005668 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5669 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005670
5671
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005672rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5673rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005674 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5676 no | yes | yes | yes
5677 Arguments :
5678 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5679 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5680 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5681 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5682 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5683 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5684 ignores case.
5685
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005686 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5687 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5688
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005689 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5690 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5691 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5692 case-sensitive.
5693
5694 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005695 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5696 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5697 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005698
5699 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5700 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5701
5702 Example :
5703 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5704 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5705
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005706 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5707 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005708
5709
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005710rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5711rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005712 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5714 no | yes | yes | yes
5715 Arguments :
5716 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5717 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5718 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5719 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5720 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5721 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5722 ignores case.
5723
5724 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5725 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5726 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5727 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005728 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005729
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005730 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5731 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5732
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005733 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5734 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5735 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5736
5737 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5738 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5739 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5740 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5741 are not case-sensitive.
5742
5743 Example :
5744 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5745 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5746
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005747 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5748 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005749
5750
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005751server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005752 Declare a server in a backend
5753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5754 no | no | yes | yes
5755 Arguments :
5756 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005757 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005758 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005759
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005760 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5761 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5762 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5763 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005764 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5765 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5766 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5767 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5768 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005769 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5770 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5771 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5772 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5773 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5774 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5775 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005776 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005777 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5778 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5779 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5780 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005781
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005782 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005783 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5784 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5785 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5786 adding this value to the client's port.
5787
5788 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5789 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005790 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005791
5792 Examples :
5793 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5794 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005795 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005796 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5797 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5798 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005799
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005800 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5801 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005802
5803
5804source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005805source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005806source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005807 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5809 yes | no | yes | yes
5810 Arguments :
5811 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5812 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005813
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005814 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005815 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5816 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5817 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5818 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5819 supported prefixes are :
5820 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5821 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5822 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005823 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005824 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5825 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5826 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5827 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005828
5829 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5830 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005831 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5832 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5833 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005834
5835 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5836 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5837 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5838 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5839 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5840 <addr>.
5841
5842 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5843 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5844 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5845 port.
5846
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005847 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5848 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5849 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5850 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005851 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005852 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5853 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5854 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5855 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5856 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5857 HTTP header.
5858
5859 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5860 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005861 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005862 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5863 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5864 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5865 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5866 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5867 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5868 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5869
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005870 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5871 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5872 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5873 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5874 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5875 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5876
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005877 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5878 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5879 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5880 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5881
5882 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5883 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5884 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5885 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5886 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5887 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5888
5889 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5890 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5891 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5892 there are two methods :
5893
5894 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5895 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5896 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5897 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5898 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5899 of the client ranges may be used.
5900
5901 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5902 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5903 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5904 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5905 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5906 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5907 same session.
5908
5909 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5910 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5911 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5912 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5913 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5914 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5915
5916 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5917 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5918 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005919 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005920
5921 Examples :
5922 backend private
5923 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5924 source 192.168.1.200
5925
5926 backend transparent_ssl1
5927 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5928 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5929
5930 backend transparent_ssl2
5931 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5932 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5933 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5934
5935 backend transparent_ssl3
5936 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5937 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5938 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5939
5940 backend transparent_smtp
5941 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5942 # with Tproxy version 4.
5943 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5944
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005945 backend transparent_http
5946 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5947 # proxy.
5948 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005950 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005951 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005953
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005954srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5955 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5957 yes | no | yes | yes
5958 Arguments :
5959 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5960 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5961 as explained at the top of this document.
5962
5963 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5964 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5965 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5966 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5967 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5968 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5969 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5970
5971 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5972 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5973 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5974 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5975 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005976 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005977 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005978 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005979
5980 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5981 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5982 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5983 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5984 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5985 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5986
5987 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5988 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5989
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005990 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5991 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005992
5993
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005994stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5995 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02005997 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005998
5999 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6000 matched.
6001
6002 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6003 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6004
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006005 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6006 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6007 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6008
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006009 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6010 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6011 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6012 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006013
6014 Example :
6015 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6016 backend stats_localhost
6017 stats enable
6018 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6019
6020 Example :
6021 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6022 backend stats_auth
6023 stats enable
6024 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6025 stats admin if TRUE
6026
6027 Example :
6028 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6029 userlist stats-auth
6030 group admin users admin
6031 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6032 group readonly users haproxy
6033 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6034
6035 backend stats_auth
6036 stats enable
6037 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6038 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6039 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6040 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6041
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006042 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6043 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6044 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006045
6046
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006047stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6048 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006050 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006051 Arguments :
6052 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6053
6054 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6055
6056 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6057 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6058 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6059 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6060 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6061 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6062
6063 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6064 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6065 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006066 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006067
6068 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6069 report using "stats scope".
6070
6071 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6072 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6073 unobvious parameters.
6074
6075 Example :
6076 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6077 backend public_www
6078 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6079 stats enable
6080 stats hide-version
6081 stats scope .
6082 stats uri /admin?stats
6083 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6084 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6085 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6086
6087 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6088 backend private_monitoring
6089 stats enable
6090 stats uri /admin?stats
6091 stats refresh 5s
6092
6093 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6094
6095
6096stats enable
6097 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006099 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006100 Arguments : none
6101
6102 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6103 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6104 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6105 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6106 - stats auth : no authentication
6107 - stats scope : no restriction
6108
6109 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6110 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6111 unobvious parameters.
6112
6113 Example :
6114 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6115 backend public_www
6116 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6117 stats enable
6118 stats hide-version
6119 stats scope .
6120 stats uri /admin?stats
6121 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6122 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6123 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6124
6125 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6126 backend private_monitoring
6127 stats enable
6128 stats uri /admin?stats
6129 stats refresh 5s
6130
6131 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6132
6133
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006134stats hide-version
6135 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006137 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006138 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006139
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006140 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6141 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6142 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6143 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6144 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6145 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006146
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006147 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6148 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6149 unobvious parameters.
6150
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006151 Example :
6152 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6153 backend public_www
6154 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006155 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006156 stats hide-version
6157 stats scope .
6158 stats uri /admin?stats
6159 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6160 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6161 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006162
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006163 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6164 backend private_monitoring
6165 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006166 stats uri /admin?stats
6167 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006168
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006169 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006170
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006171
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006172stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6173 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6174 Access control for statistics
6175
6176 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6177 no | no | yes | yes
6178
6179 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6180 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6181 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6182 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6183 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6184 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6185
6186 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6187 instance.
6188
6189 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6190 about ACL usage.
6191
6192
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006193stats realm <realm>
6194 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006196 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006197 Arguments :
6198 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6199 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6200 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6201
6202 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6203 using a backslash ('\').
6204
6205 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6206 only related to authentication.
6207
6208 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6209 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6210 unobvious parameters.
6211
6212 Example :
6213 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6214 backend public_www
6215 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6216 stats enable
6217 stats hide-version
6218 stats scope .
6219 stats uri /admin?stats
6220 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6221 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6222 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6223
6224 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6225 backend private_monitoring
6226 stats enable
6227 stats uri /admin?stats
6228 stats refresh 5s
6229
6230 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6231
6232
6233stats refresh <delay>
6234 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006236 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006237 Arguments :
6238 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6239 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6240 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6241 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6242 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6243 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6244
6245 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6246 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6247 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6248 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6249
6250 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6251 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6252 unobvious parameters.
6253
6254 Example :
6255 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6256 backend public_www
6257 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6258 stats enable
6259 stats hide-version
6260 stats scope .
6261 stats uri /admin?stats
6262 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6263 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6264 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6265
6266 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6267 backend private_monitoring
6268 stats enable
6269 stats uri /admin?stats
6270 stats refresh 5s
6271
6272 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6273
6274
6275stats scope { <name> | "." }
6276 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006278 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006279 Arguments :
6280 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6281 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6282 section in which the statement appears.
6283
6284 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6285 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6286 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6287 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6288 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6289 exists.
6290
6291 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6292 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6293 unobvious parameters.
6294
6295 Example :
6296 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6297 backend public_www
6298 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6299 stats enable
6300 stats hide-version
6301 stats scope .
6302 stats uri /admin?stats
6303 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6304 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6305 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6306
6307 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6308 backend private_monitoring
6309 stats enable
6310 stats uri /admin?stats
6311 stats refresh 5s
6312
6313 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6314
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006315
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006316stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006317 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006319 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006320
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006321 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006322 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6323
6324 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6325 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6326
6327 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6328 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006329 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006330
6331 Example :
6332 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6333 backend private_monitoring
6334 stats enable
6335 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6336 stats uri /admin?stats
6337 stats refresh 5s
6338
6339 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6340 global section.
6341
6342
6343stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006344 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6346 yes | yes | yes | yes
6347 Arguments : none
6348
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006349 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006350 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6351 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6352 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6353 - IP (socket, server)
6354 - cookie (backend, server)
6355
6356 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6357 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006358 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006359
6360 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6361
6362
6363stats show-node [ <name> ]
6364 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006366 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006367 Arguments:
6368 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6369 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6370
6371 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6372 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006373 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006374
6375 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6376 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6377 unobvious parameters.
6378
6379 Example:
6380 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6381 backend private_monitoring
6382 stats enable
6383 stats show-node Europe-1
6384 stats uri /admin?stats
6385 stats refresh 5s
6386
6387 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6388 section.
6389
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006390
6391stats uri <prefix>
6392 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006394 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006395 Arguments :
6396 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6397 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6398 query string.
6399
6400 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6401 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6402 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6403 possible to reach it in the application.
6404
6405 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006406 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006407 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6408 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6409 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6410 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6411
6412 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6413 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6414 an address or a port to statistics only.
6415
6416 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6417 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6418 unobvious parameters.
6419
6420 Example :
6421 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6422 backend public_www
6423 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6424 stats enable
6425 stats hide-version
6426 stats scope .
6427 stats uri /admin?stats
6428 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6429 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6430 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6431
6432 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6433 backend private_monitoring
6434 stats enable
6435 stats uri /admin?stats
6436 stats refresh 5s
6437
6438 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6439
6440
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006441stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6442 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006444 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006445
6446 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006447 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006448 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6449 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6450 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6451
6452 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6453 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6454 the "stick-table" statement.
6455
6456 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6457 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6458 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6459 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6460 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6461
6462 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6463 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6464 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6465 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6466 transformation rules.
6467
6468 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6469 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6470 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6471 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6472 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6473 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6474 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6475
6476 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6477 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6478 ACL based conditions.
6479
6480 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6481 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6482 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6483 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6484
6485 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6486 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6487 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6488 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6489
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006490 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6491 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6492 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6493
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006494 Example :
6495 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6496 # last 30 minutes
6497 backend pop
6498 mode tcp
6499 balance roundrobin
6500 stick store-request src
6501 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6502 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6503 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6504
6505 backend smtp
6506 mode tcp
6507 balance roundrobin
6508 stick match src table pop
6509 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6510 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6511
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006512 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006513 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006514
6515
6516stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6517 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6519 no | no | yes | yes
6520
6521 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6522 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6523 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6524 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6525
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006526 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6527 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6528 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6529
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006530 Examples :
6531 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006532 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006533
6534 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6535 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6536 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6537
6538
6539 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6540 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6541 backend http
6542 mode http
6543 balance roundrobin
6544 stick on src table https
6545 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6546 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6547 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6548
6549 backend https
6550 mode tcp
6551 balance roundrobin
6552 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6553 stick on src
6554 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6555 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6556
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006557 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006558
6559
6560stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6561 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6563 no | no | yes | yes
6564
6565 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006566 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006567 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6568 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6569 server is selected.
6570
6571 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6572 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6573 the "stick-table" statement.
6574
6575 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6576 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6577 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6578 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6579 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6580 address.
6581
6582 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6583 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6584 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6585 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6586 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6587 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6588 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6589 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6590 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6591 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6592
6593 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6594 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6595 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6596 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6597 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6598 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6599 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6600
6601 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6602 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6603 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6604 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6605
6606 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6607 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6608 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6609 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6610 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6611 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006612 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6613 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6614 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6615 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6616 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6617 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006618
6619 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6620 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6621 the request.
6622
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006623 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6624 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6625 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6626
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006627 Example :
6628 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6629 # last 30 minutes
6630 backend pop
6631 mode tcp
6632 balance roundrobin
6633 stick store-request src
6634 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6635 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6636 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6637
6638 backend smtp
6639 mode tcp
6640 balance roundrobin
6641 stick match src table pop
6642 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6643 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6644
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006645 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006646 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006647
6648
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006649stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006650 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6651 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006652 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006654 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006655
6656 Arguments :
6657 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6658 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6659 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6660 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6661
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006662 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6663 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6664 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6665 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6666
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006667 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6668 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6669 instance.
6670
6671 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6672 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6673 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6674 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6675 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6676 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006677 to 32 characters.
6678
6679 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6680 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6681 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006682 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006683 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6684 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006685
6686 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006687 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6688 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006689 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6690 increase.
6691
6692 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006693 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6694 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6695 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006696
6697 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6698 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6699 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6700 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6701 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6702 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6703 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6704 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6705 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6706 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6707 parameter (see below).
6708
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006709 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6710 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6711 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6712 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6713 soft restart.
6714
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006715 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6716
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006717 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6718 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6719 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6720 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6721 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006722 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006723 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6724 if not expiration delay is specified.
6725
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006726 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6727 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6728 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6729 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006730 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6731 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6732 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6733 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6734 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6735 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6736 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6737 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6738 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6739 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6740 types and their arguments.
6741
6742 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6743 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6744 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6745 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6746
6747 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6748 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6749 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6750 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6751
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006752 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6753 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6754 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6755 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6756 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6757 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6758
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006759 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6760 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6761 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6762 they were received.
6763
6764 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6765 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6766 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6767 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6768 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6769
6770 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6771 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6772 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6773 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6774 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6775
6776 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6777 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6778 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6779
6780 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6781 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6782 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6783 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6784 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6785
6786 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6787 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6788 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6789 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6790 the client side.
6791
6792 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6793 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6794 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6795 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6796 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6797 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6798 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6799
6800 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6801 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6802 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6803 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6804 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6805 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6806 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6807
6808 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6809 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6810 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6811 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6812 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6813 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6814
6815 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6816 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6817 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6818 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6819
6820 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6821 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6822 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6823 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6824 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6825 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6826 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6827 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6828 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6829 recommended for better fairness.
6830
6831 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6832 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6833 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6834 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6835
6836 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6837 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6838 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6839 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6840 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6841 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6842 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6843 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6844 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6845 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006846
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006847 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6848 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006849 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6850 reference it.
6851
6852 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6853 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6854 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6855 as an exclusive stickiness.
6856
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006857 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6858 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6859 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6860 something that can be ignored.
6861
6862 Example:
6863 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6864 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6865 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6866 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6867
6868 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006869 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006870
6871
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006872stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6873 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6875 no | no | yes | yes
6876
6877 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006878 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006879 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6880 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6881 server is selected.
6882
6883 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6884 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6885 the "stick-table" statement.
6886
6887 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6888 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6889 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6890 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6891
6892 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6893 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6894 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6895 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6896 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6897 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006898 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006899 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6900 rules.
6901
6902 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6903 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6904 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6905 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6906 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6907 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6908 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6909
6910 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6911 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6912 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6913 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6914
6915 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6916 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6917 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6918 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6919 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6920 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006921 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6922 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6923 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6924 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6925 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6926 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6927 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6928 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6929 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006930
6931 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6932
6933 Example :
6934 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6935 backend https
6936 mode tcp
6937 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006938 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006939 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006940
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006941 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6942 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6943
6944 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6945 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6946 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6947
6948 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6949 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006950
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006951 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6952 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6953 # at offset 44.
6954
6955 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6956 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6957
6958 # Learn on response if server hello.
6959 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006960
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006961 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6962 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6963
6964 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6965 extraction.
6966
6967
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02006968tcp-check connect [params*]
6969 Opens a new connection
6970 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6971 no | no | yes | yes
6972
6973 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
6974 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
6975 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
6976
6977 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6978 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
6979 of the sequence.
6980
6981 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6982 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6983 do.
6984
6985 Parameters :
6986 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
6987 use the TCP connection.
6988
6989 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
6990 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6991 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
6992
6993 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6994
6995 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6996
6997 Examples:
6998 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6999 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7000 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7001 option tcp-check
7002 tcp-check connect
7003 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7004 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7005 tcp-check send \r\n
7006 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7007 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7008 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7009 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7010 tcp-check send \r\n
7011 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7012 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7013
7014 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7015 option tcp-check
7016 tcp-check connect port 110
7017 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7018 tcp-check connect port 143
7019 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7020 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7021
7022 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7023
7024
7025tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7026 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7027 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7028 no | no | yes | yes
7029
7030 Arguments :
7031 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7032 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7033 binary.
7034 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7035 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7036 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7037
7038 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7039 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7040 with the usual backslash ('\').
7041 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7042 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7043 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7044 used upper or lower case.
7045
7046
7047 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7048
7049 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7050 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7051 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7052 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7053 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7054 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7055 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7056 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7057
7058 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7059 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7060 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7061 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7062 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7063 expression.
7064
7065 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7066 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7067 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7068 this exact hexadecimal string.
7069 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7070
7071 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7072 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7073 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7074 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7075 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7076 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7077 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7078 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7079 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7080 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7081 the null character.
7082
7083 Examples :
7084 # perform a POP check
7085 option tcp-check
7086 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7087
7088 # perform an IMAP check
7089 option tcp-check
7090 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7091
7092 # look for the redis master server
7093 option tcp-check
7094 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7095 tcp-check expect +PONG
7096 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7097 tcp-check expect string role:master
7098 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7099 tcp-check expect string +OK
7100
7101
7102 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7103 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7104
7105
7106tcp-check send <data>
7107 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7108 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7109 no | no | yes | yes
7110
7111 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7112 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7113
7114 Examples :
7115 # look for the redis master server
7116 option tcp-check
7117 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7118 tcp-check expect string role:master
7119
7120 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7121 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7122
7123
7124tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7125 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7126 tcp health check
7127 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7128 no | no | yes | yes
7129
7130 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7131 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7132 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7133 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7134 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7135 hexadecimal string.
7136 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7137
7138 Examples :
7139 # redis check in binary
7140 option tcp-check
7141 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7142 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7143
7144
7145 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7146 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7147
7148
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007149tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7150 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7152 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007153 Arguments :
7154 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007155 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7156 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007157
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007158 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007159
7160 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7161 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007162 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7163 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7164 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7165 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7166 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7167 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007168
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007169 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7170 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7171 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7172 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007173
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007174 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007175 - accept :
7176 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7177 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7178 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007179
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007180 - reject :
7181 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7182 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7183 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7184 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7185 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7186 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7187 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7188 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7189 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7190 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7191 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7192 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007193
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007194 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7195 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7196 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7197 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7198 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7199 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7200 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7201 hosts.
7202
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007203 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7204 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7205 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7206 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7207 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7208 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7209 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7210 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7211 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7212 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7213 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7214
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007215 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007216 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7217 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7218 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007219 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7220 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007221 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007222 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7223 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7224 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7225 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7226 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007227
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007228 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007229 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007230 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007231 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7232 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7233 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7234 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007235
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007236 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7237 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7238 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7239 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007240
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007241 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7242 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7243 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7244 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7245 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007246 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7247 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7248 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7249 layer7 information is extracted.
7250
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007251 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7252 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7253 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7254 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7255 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007256
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007257 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7258 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7259 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007260
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007261 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7262 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7263 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007264
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007265 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007266 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007267 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007268
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007269 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7270 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7271 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007272
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007273 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007274 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7275 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007276
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007277 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7278
7279 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7280
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007281 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7282
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007283 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007284
7285
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007286tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7287 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007289 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007290 Arguments :
7291 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007292 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007293 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7294 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007295
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007296 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007297
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007298 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7299 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7300 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7301 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7302 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007303
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007304 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7305 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7306 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7307 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007308 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7309 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7310 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7311 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7312 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7313 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007314 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007315 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007316
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007317 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7318 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7319 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7320 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007321
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007322 Four types of actions are supported :
7323 - accept : the request is accepted
7324 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7325 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007326 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007327
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007328 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7329 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007330
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007331 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7332 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7333 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7334 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7335 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7336 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007338 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007339 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7340 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007341
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007342 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007343 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7344 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7345 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7346 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007347 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7348 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7349 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007350
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007351 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7352 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7353 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7354 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7355
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007356 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007357 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7358 # and reject everything else.
7359 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7360 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007361 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007362 tcp-request content reject
7363
7364 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007365 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7366 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7367 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007368 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007369
7370 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7371 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7372 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007373 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007374 tcp-request content reject
7375
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007376 Example:
7377 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7378 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007379 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007380
7381 Example:
7382 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7383 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007384 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007385
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007386 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7387 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7388
7389 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007390 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007391 # protecting all our sites
7392 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007393 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7394 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007395 ...
7396 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7397
7398 backend http_dynamic
7399 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007400 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007401 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007402 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7403 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7404 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007405 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007406
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007407 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007408
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007409 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007410
7411
7412tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7413 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007415 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007416 Arguments :
7417 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7418 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7419 as explained at the top of this document.
7420
7421 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7422 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7423 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7424 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7425 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7426
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007427 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7428 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7429 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7430 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7431
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007432 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7433 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007434 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007435 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007436 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7437 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7438 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7439 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007440
7441 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7442 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7443 it pass through unaffected.
7444
7445 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7446 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7447 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007448 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007449 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7450 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007451 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7452 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7453 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007454
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007455 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007456 "timeout client".
7457
7458
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007459tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7460 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7462 no | no | yes | yes
7463 Arguments :
7464 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007465 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007466
7467 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7468
7469 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7470 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7471 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007472 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7473 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007474
7475 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7476
7477 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7478 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7479 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7480 inserted.
7481
7482 Two types of actions are supported :
7483 - accept :
7484 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7485 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7486 the rules evaluation.
7487
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007488 - close :
7489 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7490 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7491 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7492 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7493 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7494 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007495 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007496 protocols.
7497
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007498 - reject :
7499 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7500 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007501 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007502
7503 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7504 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7505 for changing the default action to a reject.
7506
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007507 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7508 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7509 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7510 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007511 period.
7512
7513 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7514
7515 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7516
7517
7518tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7519 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7521 no | no | yes | yes
7522 Arguments :
7523 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7524 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7525 as explained at the top of this document.
7526
7527 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7528
7529
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007530timeout check <timeout>
7531 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7532 established.
7533
7534 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7535 yes | no | yes | yes
7536 Arguments:
7537 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7538 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7539 as explained at the top of this document.
7540
7541 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7542 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7543 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7544 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007545 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7546 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7547 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007548
7549 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7550 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7551
7552 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7553 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007554 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007555
7556 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7557 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7558 forget about it.
7559
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007560 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7561 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007562
7563
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007564timeout client <timeout>
7565timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7566 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7568 yes | yes | yes | no
7569 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007570 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007571 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7572 as explained at the top of this document.
7573
7574 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7575 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7576 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7577 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7578 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7579 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7580 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7581 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007582 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007583 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007584 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7585 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007586 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7587 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007588
7589 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7590 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7591 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7592 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7593 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7594 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7595
7596 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7597 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7598 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7599
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007600 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007601
7602
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007603timeout client-fin <timeout>
7604 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7606 yes | yes | yes | no
7607 Arguments :
7608 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7609 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7610 as explained at the top of this document.
7611
7612 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7613 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7614 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7615 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7616 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7617 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7618 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7619 down in one direction.
7620
7621 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7622 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7623 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7624
7625 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7626
7627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007628timeout connect <timeout>
7629timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7630 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7632 yes | no | yes | yes
7633 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007634 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007635 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7636 as explained at the top of this document.
7637
7638 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007639 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007640 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007641 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007642 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7643 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007644
7645 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7646 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7647 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7648 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7649 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7650 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7651
7652 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7653 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7654 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7655
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007656 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7657 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007658
7659
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007660timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7661 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7663 yes | yes | yes | yes
7664 Arguments :
7665 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7666 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7667 as explained at the top of this document.
7668
7669 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7670 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7671 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7672 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7673 once the request has started to present itself.
7674
7675 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7676 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7677 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7678 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7679 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7680
7681 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7682 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7683 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7684 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7685
7686 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7687 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7688 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7689 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7690 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007691 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007692
7693 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7694 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7695 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7696 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7697
7698 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7699
7700
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007701timeout http-request <timeout>
7702 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007704 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007705 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007706 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007707 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7708 as explained at the top of this document.
7709
7710 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7711 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7712 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7713 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7714 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7715 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7716 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007717 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7718 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7719 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7720 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7721 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7722 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7723 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007724
7725 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7726 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007727 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7728 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007729
7730 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7731 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7732 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7733 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7734 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7735
7736 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007737 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7738 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7739 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007740
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007741 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007742
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007743
7744timeout queue <timeout>
7745 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7747 yes | no | yes | yes
7748 Arguments :
7749 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7750 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7751 as explained at the top of this document.
7752
7753 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7754 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7755 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7756 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7757 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7758
7759 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7760 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7761 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7762 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7763
7764 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7765
7766
7767timeout server <timeout>
7768timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7769 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7771 yes | no | yes | yes
7772 Arguments :
7773 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7774 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7775 as explained at the top of this document.
7776
7777 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7778 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7779 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7780 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7781 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7782 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7783 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7784
7785 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7786 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7787 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7788 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7789 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007790 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007791 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007792 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7793 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7794 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7795 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007796
7797 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7798 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7799 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7800 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7801 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7802 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7803
7804 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7805 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7806 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7807
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007808 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007809
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007810
7811timeout server-fin <timeout>
7812 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
7813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7814 yes | no | yes | yes
7815 Arguments :
7816 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7817 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7818 as explained at the top of this document.
7819
7820 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7821 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7822 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7823 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7824 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
7825 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7826 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7827 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
7828 situations, it should not be needed.
7829
7830 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7831 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7832 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
7833
7834 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
7835
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007836
7837timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007838 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7840 yes | yes | yes | yes
7841 Arguments :
7842 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7843 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7844 as explained at the top of this document.
7845
7846 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7847 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7848 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7849
7850 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7851 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7852 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7853 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007854 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007855
7856 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7857
7858
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007859timeout tunnel <timeout>
7860 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7862 yes | no | yes | yes
7863 Arguments :
7864 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7865 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7866 as explained at the top of this document.
7867
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007868 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007869 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7870 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7871 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7872 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7873 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7874 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7875 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7876 specified.
7877
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007878 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
7879 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
7880 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
7881 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
7882 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
7883 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
7884 state.
7885
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007886 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7887 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7888 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7889 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7890 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7891
7892 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7893 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7894 forget about it.
7895
7896 Example :
7897 defaults http
7898 option http-server-close
7899 timeout connect 5s
7900 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007901 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007902 timeout server 30s
7903 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7904
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007905 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007906
7907
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007908transparent (deprecated)
7909 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007911 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007912 Arguments : none
7913
7914 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7915 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7916 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7917 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7918 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7919 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7920 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7921 appropriate server.
7922
7923 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7924
7925 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7926 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7927
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007928 See also: "option transparent"
7929
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007930unique-id-format <string>
7931 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7933 yes | yes | yes | no
7934 Arguments :
7935 <string> is a log-format string.
7936
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007937 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7938 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7939 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7940 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007941
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007942 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7943 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7944 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7945 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7946 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7947 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7948 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7949 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007950
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007951 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7952 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007953
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007954 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007955
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007956 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007957
7958 will generate:
7959
7960 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7961
7962 See also: "unique-id-header"
7963
7964unique-id-header <name>
7965 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7967 yes | yes | yes | no
7968 Arguments :
7969 <name> is the name of the header.
7970
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007971 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7972 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007973
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007974 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007975
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007976 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007977 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7978
7979 will generate:
7980
7981 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7982
7983 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007984
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007985use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007986 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7988 no | yes | yes | no
7989 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007990 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
7991 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007992
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007993 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
7994 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007995
7996 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7997 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7998 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007999 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8000 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8001 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8002 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008003
8004 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8005 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8006 assign the backend.
8007
8008 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8009 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8010 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8011 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8012 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8013 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8014
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008015 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008016 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008017 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8018 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8019 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8020
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008021 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8022 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8023 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8024 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8025 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8026 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8027 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8028 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8029 cannot be forced from the request.
8030
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008031 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008032 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8033 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8034
8035 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8036 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008037
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008038
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008039use-server <server> if <condition>
8040use-server <server> unless <condition>
8041 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8043 no | no | yes | yes
8044 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008045 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008046
8047 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8048
8049 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8050 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8051 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8052
8053 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8054 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8055 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8056 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8057 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8058 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8059 matches will assign the server.
8060
8061 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8062 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8063 with the next rules until one matches.
8064
8065 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8066 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8067 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8068 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8069
8070 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8071 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8072 stripped.
8073
8074 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8075 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8076 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8077 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8078
8079 Example :
8080 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8081 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8082 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8083 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8084 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8085 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8086 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8087 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8088 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8089
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008090 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008091
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008092
80935. Bind and Server options
8094--------------------------
8095
8096The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8097depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8098settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8099written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8100described in this section.
8101
8102
81035.1. Bind options
8104-----------------
8105
8106The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8107as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8108no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8109parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8110while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8111provided immediately after the setting name.
8112
8113The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8114
8115accept-proxy
8116 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
8117 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
8118 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8119 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8120 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8121 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8122 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8123 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8124 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008125 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8126 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008127
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008128alpn <protocols>
8129 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8130 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8131 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8132 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8133 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8134 initial NPN extension.
8135
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008136backlog <backlog>
8137 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8138 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8139
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008140ecdhe <named curve>
8141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008142 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8143 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008144
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008145ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8147 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8148 client's certificate.
8149
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008150ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8151 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8152 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8153 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8154 error is ignored.
8155
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008156ciphers <ciphers>
8157 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8158 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008159 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008160 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8161 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8162
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008163crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008164 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8165 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8166 to verify client's certificate.
8167
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008168crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8170 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8171 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8172 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8173 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8174 file.
8175
8176 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8177 are loaded.
8178
8179 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
8180 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
8181 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8182 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8183 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8184 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8185 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8186 www.sub.example.org).
8187
8188 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8189 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8190 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8191 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8192 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8193
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008194 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008195
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008196 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8197 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008198 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008199 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8200 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8201 clients).
8202
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008203crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008204 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8205 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008206 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008207 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008208
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008209crt-list <file>
8210 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008211 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8212 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008213
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008214 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008215
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008216 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8217 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8218 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8219 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8220 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8221 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8222 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8223 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008224
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008225defer-accept
8226 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8227 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8228 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8229 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8230 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8231 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8232 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8233 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8234 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8235 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8236 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8237
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008238force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008239 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008240 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8241 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8242
8243force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008244 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008245 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8246
8247force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008248 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008249 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8250
8251force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008252 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008253 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8254
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008255gid <gid>
8256 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8257 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8258 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8259 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8260 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8261
8262group <group>
8263 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8264 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8265 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8266 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8267 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8268
8269id <id>
8270 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8271 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8272 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8273 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8274
8275interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008276 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8277 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8278 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8279 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8280 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8281 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8282 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008283
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008284level <level>
8285 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8286 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8287 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8288 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8289 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8290 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8291 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8292 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8293 counters).
8294 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8295 all counters).
8296
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008297maxconn <maxconn>
8298 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8299 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8300 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8301 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8302 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8303 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8304 eat all memory.
8305
8306mode <mode>
8307 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8308 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8309 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8310 UNIX sockets.
8311
8312mss <maxseg>
8313 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8314 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8315 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8316 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8317 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8318 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8319 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8320 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8321 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8322 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8323 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8324
8325name <name>
8326 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8327 page.
8328
8329nice <nice>
8330 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8331 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8332 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8333 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8334 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8335 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8336 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8337 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8338 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8339 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8340 one for an RDP socket.
8341
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008342no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008343 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008344 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008345 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008346 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8347 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008348
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008349no-tls-tickets
8350 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8351 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8352 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8353 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8354
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008355no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008357 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008358 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8359 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8360 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008361
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008362no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008364 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008365 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8366 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8367 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008368
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008369no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008370 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008371 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008372 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8373 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8374 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008375
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008376npn <protocols>
8377 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8378 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8379 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8380 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008381 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8382 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008383
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008384process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8385 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8386 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8387 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8388 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8389 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8390 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8391 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008392 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8393 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8394 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8395 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8396 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8397 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8398 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008399
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008400ssl
8401 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008402 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008403 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8404 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8405 to deciphered contents.
8406
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008407strict-sni
8408 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8409 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8410 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8411 See the "crt" option for more information.
8412
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008413tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008414 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008415 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8416 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8417 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8418 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8419 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8420 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8421 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008422 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8423 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8424 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008425
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008426transparent
8427 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8428 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8429 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8430 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8431 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8432 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8433 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8434 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8435 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8436 so check for support with your vendor.
8437
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008438v4v6
8439 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8440 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8441 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8442 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008443 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008444
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008445v6only
8446 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8447 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8448 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008449 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8450 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008451
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008452uid <uid>
8453 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8454 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8455 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8456 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8457 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8458
8459user <user>
8460 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8461 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8462 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8463 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8464 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8465
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008466verify [none|optional|required]
8467 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8468 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8469 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8470 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8471 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008472 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8473 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8474 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8475 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008476
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020084775.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008478------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008479
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008480The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8481which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8482arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8483settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8484after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8485Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8486address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008488 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008489 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008491The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008492
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008493addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008494 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8495 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8496 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8497 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8498 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008500 Supported in default-server: No
8501
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008502agent-check
8503 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008504 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8505 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8506 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8507 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008508
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008509 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008510 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8511 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8512
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008513 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8514 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008515
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008516 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8517 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8518 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008519
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008520 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8521 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8522 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008523
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008524 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8525 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8526 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8527 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8528 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8529 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8530 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008531
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008532 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8533 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008534
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008535 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8536 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8537 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8538 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8539 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8540 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8541 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8542 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8543 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008544
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008545 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8546 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008547 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8548 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8549 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8550 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008551
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008552 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8553 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008554
8555 Supported in default-server: No
8556
8557agent-inter <delay>
8558 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8559 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8560
8561 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8562 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8563 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8564 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8565 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8566 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8567 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8568 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8569 of backends use the same servers.
8570
8571 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8572
8573 Supported in default-server: Yes
8574
8575agent-port <port>
8576 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8577
8578 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8579
8580 Supported in default-server: Yes
8581
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008582backup
8583 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8584 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8585 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8586 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8587 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8588 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008589
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008590 Supported in default-server: No
8591
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008592ca-file <cafile>
8593 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8594 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8595 server's certificate.
8596
8597 Supported in default-server: No
8598
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008599check
8600 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008601 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8602 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8603 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8604 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8605 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8606 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8607 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008608 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8609 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8610 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008612 Supported in default-server: No
8613
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008614check-send-proxy
8615 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8616 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8617 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8618 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8619 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8620 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8621 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8622
8623 Supported in default-server: No
8624
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008625check-ssl
8626 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8627 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8628 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8629 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008630 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008631 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8632 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8633 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8634 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8635
8636 Supported in default-server: No
8637
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008638ciphers <ciphers>
8639 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008640 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008641 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8642 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8643 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8644 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8645 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8646 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8647
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008648 Supported in default-server: No
8649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008650cookie <value>
8651 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8652 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8653 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8654 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8655 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8656 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8657 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008659 Supported in default-server: No
8660
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008661crl-file <crlfile>
8662 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8663 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8664 to verify server's certificate.
8665
8666 Supported in default-server: No
8667
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008668crt <cert>
8669 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8670 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8671 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8672 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8673 certificate request.
8674
8675 Supported in default-server: No
8676
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008677disabled
8678 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8679 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8680 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8681 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8682 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8683
8684 Supported in default-server: No
8685
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008686error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008687 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8688 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8689 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008691 Supported in default-server: Yes
8692
8693 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008695fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008696 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8697 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8698 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8699
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008700 Supported in default-server: Yes
8701
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008702force-sslv3
8703 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8704 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8705 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8706
8707 Supported in default-server: No
8708
8709force-tlsv10
8710 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8711 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8712
8713 Supported in default-server: No
8714
8715force-tlsv11
8716 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8717 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8718
8719 Supported in default-server: No
8720
8721force-tlsv12
8722 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8723 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8724
8725 Supported in default-server: No
8726
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008727id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008728 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8729 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8730 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008731
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008732 Supported in default-server: No
8733
8734inter <delay>
8735fastinter <delay>
8736downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008737 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8738 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8739 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8740 between checks depending on the server state :
8741
8742 Server state | Interval used
8743 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8744 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8745 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8746 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8747 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8748 or yet unchecked. |
8749 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8750 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8751 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008753 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8754 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8755 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8756 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008757 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8758 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8759 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8760 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8761 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008762
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008763 Supported in default-server: Yes
8764
8765maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008766 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8767 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8768 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8769 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8770 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8771 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8772 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8773 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008775 Supported in default-server: Yes
8776
8777maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008778 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8779 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8780 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8781 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8782 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8783 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8784 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8785
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008786 Supported in default-server: Yes
8787
8788minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008789 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8790 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8791 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8792 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8793 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8794 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008795 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008796 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008797
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008798 Supported in default-server: Yes
8799
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008800no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008801 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8802 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008803 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008804
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008805 Supported in default-server: No
8806
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008807no-tls-tickets
8808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8809 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8810 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8811 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8812
8813 Supported in default-server: No
8814
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008815no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008816 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008817 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8818 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008819 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8820 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008821
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008822 Supported in default-server: No
8823
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008824no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008825 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008826 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8827 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008828 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8829 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008830
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008831 Supported in default-server: No
8832
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008833no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008834 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008835 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8836 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008837 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8838 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008839
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008840 Supported in default-server: No
8841
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008842non-stick
8843 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8844 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8845 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8846
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008847 Supported in default-server: No
8848
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008849observe <mode>
8850 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8851 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8852 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8853 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8854 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8855 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008856 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008858 Supported in default-server: No
8859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008860 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008862on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008863 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8864 Currently, four modes are available:
8865 - fastinter: force fastinter
8866 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8867 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8868 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8869 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8870
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008871 Supported in default-server: Yes
8872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008873 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8874
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008875on-marked-down <action>
8876 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8877 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008878 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8879 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8880 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8881 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8882 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8883 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8884 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8885 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008886
8887 Actions are disabled by default
8888
8889 Supported in default-server: Yes
8890
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008891on-marked-up <action>
8892 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8893 Currently one action is available:
8894 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8895 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8896 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8897 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8898 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8899 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8900 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8901 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8902
8903 Actions are disabled by default
8904
8905 Supported in default-server: Yes
8906
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008907port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008908 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8909 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8910 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8911 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8912 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8913 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8914
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008915 Supported in default-server: Yes
8916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008917redir <prefix>
8918 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8919 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8920 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8921 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8922 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8923 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8924 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8925 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008926 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008927 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8928 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8929 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8930 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8931 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8932
8933 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8934
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008935 Supported in default-server: No
8936
8937rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008938 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8939 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8940 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008942 Supported in default-server: Yes
8943
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008944send-proxy
8945 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8946 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8947 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8948 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8949 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8950 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8951 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8952 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8953 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008954 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8955 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8956 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8957 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8958 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008959
8960 Supported in default-server: No
8961
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04008962send-proxy-v2
8963 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
8964 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8965 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8966 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8967 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
8968 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
8969 option of the "bind" keyword.
8970
8971 Supported in default-server: No
8972
8973send-proxy-v2-ssl
8974 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
8975 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8976 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8977 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8978 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
8979 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
8980 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
8981 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
8982
8983 Supported in default-server: No
8984
8985send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
8986 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
8987 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8988 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8989 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8990 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
8991 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
8992 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
8993 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
8994 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
8995
8996 Supported in default-server: No
8997
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008998slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008999 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9000 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9001 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9002 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9003 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9004 parameters :
9005
9006 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9007 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9008
9009 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9010 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9011 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9012 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9013
9014 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9015 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9016 seen as failed.
9017
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009018 Supported in default-server: Yes
9019
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009020source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009021source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009022source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009023 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9024 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9025 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9026 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9027
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009028 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9029 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9030 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9031 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9032 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9033 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9034 server.
9035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009036 Supported in default-server: No
9037
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009038ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009039 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9040 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9041 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9042 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9043 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9044 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009045 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009046
9047 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009049track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009050 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9051 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9052 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9053 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009054 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009056 Supported in default-server: No
9057
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009058verify [none|required]
9059 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009060 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9061 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9062 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9063 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009064 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9065 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9066 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009067
9068 Supported in default-server: No
9069
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009070verifyhost <hostname>
9071 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9072 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9073 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9074 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9075 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9076 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9077
9078 Supported in default-server: No
9079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009080weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009081 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9082 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9083 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009084 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9085 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9086 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9087 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9088 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9089 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009090
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009091 Supported in default-server: Yes
9092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009093
90946. HTTP header manipulation
9095---------------------------
9096
9097In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9098response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9099request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9100which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009101against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009102
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009103If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9104to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9105but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9106HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9107stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9108because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9109a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9110still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009112This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9113in section 4.2 :
9114
9115 - reqadd <string>
9116 - reqallow <search>
9117 - reqiallow <search>
9118 - reqdel <search>
9119 - reqidel <search>
9120 - reqdeny <search>
9121 - reqideny <search>
9122 - reqpass <search>
9123 - reqipass <search>
9124 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9125 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9126 - reqtarpit <search>
9127 - reqitarpit <search>
9128 - rspadd <string>
9129 - rspdel <search>
9130 - rspidel <search>
9131 - rspdeny <search>
9132 - rspideny <search>
9133 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9134 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9135
9136With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9137is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9138parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9139prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9140Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9141
9142 \t for a tab
9143 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9144 \n for a new line (LF)
9145 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9146 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9147 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9148 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9149 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9150
9151The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9152portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9153above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9154regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
91559 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9156is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9157
9158The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9159after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9160
9161Notes related to these keywords :
9162---------------------------------
9163 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9164 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9165 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9166
9167 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9168 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9169 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9170
9171 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9172 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9173 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9174 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9175 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9176
9177 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9178 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9179 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9180 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9181 useless headers before adding new ones.
9182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009183 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009184 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9185
9186 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9187 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9188 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9189
9190 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9191 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009192 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009193
9194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091957. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9196----------------------------------
9197
9198Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9199client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9200The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9201these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9202but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9203data called patterns.
9204
9205
92067.1. ACL basics
9207---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009208
9209The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9210content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9211from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9212simple :
9213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009214 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009215 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009216 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9217 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009219The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9220adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009221
9222In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009224 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009225
9226This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9227Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9228and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009229an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9230conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9231as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9232are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009233
9234ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9235'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9236which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9237
9238There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9239performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009241The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9242specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9243this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009244methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9245ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009246
9247Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9248 - boolean
9249 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9250 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9251 - string
9252 - data block
9253
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009254Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9255converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9256would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9257The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9258which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9259
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009260Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9261keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9262fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9263which are summarized in the table below :
9264
9265 +---------------------+-----------------+
9266 | Sample or converter | Default |
9267 | output type | matching method |
9268 +---------------------+-----------------+
9269 | boolean | bool |
9270 +---------------------+-----------------+
9271 | integer | int |
9272 +---------------------+-----------------+
9273 | ip | ip |
9274 +---------------------+-----------------+
9275 | string | str |
9276 +---------------------+-----------------+
9277 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9278 +---------------------+-----------------+
9279
9280Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9281matching method, see below.
9282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009283The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9284 - boolean
9285 - integer or integer range
9286 - IP address / network
9287 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9288 - regular expression
9289 - hex block
9290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009291The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9292
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009293 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9294 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009295 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009296 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009297 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009298 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009299 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009301The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9302read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9303if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9304lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9305will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9306beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9307a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9308lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9309exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9310
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009311The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9312parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9313ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9314a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9315check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9316
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009317The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9318socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9319file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009321Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9322loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9323
9324 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9325
9326In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9327the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9328case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9329as well.
9330
9331The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9332sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9333do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9334methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9335is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9336obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9337followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9338default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9339that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9340string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9341
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009342The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9343By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9344string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9345resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9346server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9347waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9348flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9349function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009351There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9352sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9353be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009354
9355 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9356 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009357 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9358 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9359 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9360 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009361
9362 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9363 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009364 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009365
9366 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009367 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009368
9369 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009370 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009371
9372 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9373 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9374
9375 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9376 binary or string samples.
9377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009378 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9379 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009381 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9382 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9383 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009385 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9386 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009388 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9389 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009391 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9392 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009394 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9395 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009396 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009398 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9399 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9400 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009401
9402For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9403request, it is possible to do :
9404
9405 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9406
9407In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9408buffer, one would use the following acl :
9409
9410 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9411
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009412On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9413possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9414
9415 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009417All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9418criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9419method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9420to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9421criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9422the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009424If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009425the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9426For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009428 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9429 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9430 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9431 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009432
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009433
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009434The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9435types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9436combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9437brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9438default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009440 +-------------------------------------------------+
9441 | Input sample type |
9442 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009443 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009444 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9445 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9446 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009447 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009448 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009449 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009450 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009451 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009452 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009453 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009454 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009455 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009456 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009457 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009458 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009459 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009460 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009461 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009462 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009463 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009464 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009465 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009466 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009467 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009468 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9469 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9470 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009471
9472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094737.1.1. Matching booleans
9474------------------------
9475
9476In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9477Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9478When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9479that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9480
9481Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9482return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9483"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9484
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094867.1.2. Matching integers
9487------------------------
9488
9489Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9490enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9491to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9492
9493Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9494matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9495lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009496
9497For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9498unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9499representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9500
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009501As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9502two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9503instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9504ranges and operators.
9505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009506For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009507operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9508Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9509of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009510
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009511Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009512
9513 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9514 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9515 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9516 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9517 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009519For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009520
9521 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9522
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009523This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9524
9525 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9526
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095287.1.3. Matching strings
9529-----------------------
9530
9531String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9532different forms :
9533
9534 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9535 patterns ;
9536
9537 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9538 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9539
9540 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9541 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9542
9543 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9544 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9545
9546 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9547 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9548 matches.
9549
9550 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9551 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9552 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009553
9554String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9555exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9556characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9557string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9558to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009559before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009560
9561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095627.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9563---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009564
9565Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9566they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9567possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9568passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9569the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009570the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9571match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009572
9573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9575-------------------------------------
9576
9577It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9578not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9579a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9580to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9581digits may be used upper or lower case.
9582
9583Example :
9584 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9585 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9586
9587
95887.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9589---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009590
9591IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9592netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9593within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009594host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009595difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9596at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9597does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9598parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009599
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009600IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9601Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9602trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9603IPv6 patterns.
9604
9605HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9606following situations :
9607 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9608 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9609 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9610 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9611 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9612 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9613 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9614 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9615 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9616 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009618
96197.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9620----------------------------------
9621
9622Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9623combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9624
9625 - AND (implicit)
9626 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9627 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009629A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009631 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009633Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9634indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009636For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9637"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9638requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9639is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9640
9641 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9642 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9643 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9644 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9645
9646To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9647and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9648
9649 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9650 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9651 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9652 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9653
9654 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9655 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9656 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9657 use_backend www if host_www
9658
9659It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9660expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9661be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9662the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9663
9664 The following rule :
9665
9666 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9667 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9668
9669 Can also be written that way :
9670
9671 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9672
9673It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9674to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9675simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9676sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9677good use is the following :
9678
9679 With named ACLs :
9680
9681 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9682 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9683 monitor fail if site_dead
9684
9685 With anonymous ACLs :
9686
9687 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9688
9689See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9690
9691
96927.3. Fetching samples
9693---------------------
9694
9695Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9696against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9697sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9698ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9699of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9700available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9701
9702This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9703Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9704compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9705deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9706
9707The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9708matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9709method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9710indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9711
9712As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9713when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9714mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9715the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9716ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9717
9718Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9719multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9720when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9721incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9722are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9723is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9724all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9725
9726Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9727 - name
9728 - name(arg1)
9729 - name(arg1,arg2)
9730
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009731
97327.3.1. Converters
9733-----------------
9734
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009735Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9736of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9737is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9738was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9739has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9740unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9741
9742These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9743sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9744the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9745support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009747The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009748
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009749base64
9750 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9751 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9752 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9753
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009754lower
9755 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9756 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9757 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009758
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009759upper
9760 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9761 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9762 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009763
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009764hex
9765 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9766 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9767 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9768 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009769
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009770ipmask(<mask>)
9771 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9772 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9773 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9774 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009775
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009776http_date([<offset>])
9777 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9778 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9779 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9780 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9781 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9782 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009783
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009784language(<value>[,<default>])
9785 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9786 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9787 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9788 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9789 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9790 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9791 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9792 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9793 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9794 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9795 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9796 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009797
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009798 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009799
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009800 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9801 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009802
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009803 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9804 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9805 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9806 use_backend spanish if es
9807 use_backend french if fr
9808 use_backend english if en
9809 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009810
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009811map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9812map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9813map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9814 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9815 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9816 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9817 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9818 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9819 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9820 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9821 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009822
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009823 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9824 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9825 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009826
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009827 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
9828 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009829
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009830 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
9831 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9832 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
9833 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +02009834 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
9835 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009836 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
9837 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9838 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
9839 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9840 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
9841 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9842 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
9843 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9844 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
9845 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9846 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
9847 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9848 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
9849 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009850
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009851 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
9852 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
9853 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
9854 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9855 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009856
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009857 Example :
9858
9859 # this is a comment and is ignored
9860 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9861 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9862 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9863 | | | `---------- value
9864 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
9865 | `---------------------------- key
9866 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9867
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009868
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020098697.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009870--------------------------------------------
9871
9872A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9873not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9874"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9875The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9876
9877always_false : boolean
9878 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9879 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9880
9881always_true : boolean
9882 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9883 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9884
9885avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009886 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009887 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9888 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9889 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9890 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9891 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9892 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9893 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9894 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9895 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9896 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9897 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9898 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9899 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009901be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009902 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9903 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9904 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9905 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9906 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009908be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9909 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9910 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9911 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9912 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9913 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9914 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009915
9916 Example :
9917 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9918 backend dynamic
9919 mode http
9920 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9921 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009923connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9924 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009925 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009926 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9927 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009928
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009929 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009930 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009931 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9932
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009933 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9934 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009935
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009936 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009937 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009938 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009939 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9940 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009941 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009942 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009943
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009944 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9945 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009946 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009947 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009948
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009949date([<offset>]) : integer
9950 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9951 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9952 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9953 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009954 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9955
9956 Example :
9957
9958 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9959 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009960
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009961env(<name>) : string
9962 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9963 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9964 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9965 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9966 certain way.
9967
9968 Examples :
9969 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9970 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9971
9972 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9973 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009975fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9976 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009977 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9978 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009979 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9980 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9981 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9982 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9983 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009985fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9986 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9987 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9988 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9989 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9990 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9991 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9992 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9993 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009994
9995 Example :
9996 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9997 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9998 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9999 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10000 frontend mail
10001 bind :25
10002 mode tcp
10003 maxconn 100
10004 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10005 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10006 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10007 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010009nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10010 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10011 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10012 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010013 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10014 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10015 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010017queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010018 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10019 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10020 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010021 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10022 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10023 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10024 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10025 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10026
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010027rand([<range>]) : integer
10028 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10029 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10030 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10031 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10032 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010034srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10035 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10036 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10037 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10038 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10039 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10040 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10041 methods.
10042
10043srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10044 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10045 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10046 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10047 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10048 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10049 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10050 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10051
10052srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10053 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10054 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010055 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010056 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10057 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10058 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10059 overloading servers).
10060
10061 Example :
10062 # Redirect to a separate back
10063 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10064 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10065 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10066
10067table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10068 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10069 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10070
10071table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10072 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10073 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10074 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10075
10076
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200100777.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010078----------------------------------
10079
10080The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10081closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10082methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10083sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10084TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010085the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10086counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10087"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010088argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10089the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10090this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010091
10092be_id : integer
10093 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10094 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10095
10096dst : ip
10097 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10098 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10099 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10100 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10101 RFC 4291.
10102
10103dst_conn : integer
10104 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10105 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10106 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10107 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10108 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10109 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10110 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10111 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010113dst_port : integer
10114 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10115 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10116 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10117 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10118 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10119 an HTTP header.
10120
10121fe_id : integer
10122 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10123 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10124 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10125
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010126sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010127sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10128sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10129sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010130 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10131 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10132 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10133
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010134sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010135sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10136sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10137sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010138 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10139 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10140 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10141
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010142sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010143sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10144sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10145sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010146 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10147 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010148 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10149 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10150 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010151
10152 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10153 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010154 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10155 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10156 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010157 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10158 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10159
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010160sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010161sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10162sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10163sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010164 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10165 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10166
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010167sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010168sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10169sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10170sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010171 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10172 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10173 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10174
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010175sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010176sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10177sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10178sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010179 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10180 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10181 See also src_conn_rate.
10182
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010183sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010184sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10185sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10186sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010187 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010188 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010189
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010190sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010191sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10192sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10193sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010194 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10195 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10196 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010197 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10198 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10199 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010200
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010201sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010202sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10203sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10204sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010205 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10206 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10207 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10208
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010209sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010210sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10211sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10212sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010213 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10214 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10215 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10216 src_http_err_rate.
10217
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010218sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010219sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10220sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10221sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010222 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10223 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10224 src_http_req_cnt.
10225
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010226sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010227sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10228sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10229sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010230 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10231 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10232 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10233 src_http_req_rate.
10234
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010235sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010236sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10237sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10238sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010239 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010240 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10241 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10242 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10243 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010244
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010245 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10246 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010247 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10248
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010249sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010250sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10251sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10252sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010253 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10254 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10255 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10256 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
10257
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010258sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010259sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10260sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10261sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010262 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10263 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10264 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10265 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
10266
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010267sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010268sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10269sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10270sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010271 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10272 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10273 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10274 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010275 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010276 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10277
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010278sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010279sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10280sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10281sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010282 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10283 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10284 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10285 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10286 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010287 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010288
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010289sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010290sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10291sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10292sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010293 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10294 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10295 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10296
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010297sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010298sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10299sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10300sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010301 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10302 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010303 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010304 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10305 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010306 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10307 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10308 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010310so_id : integer
10311 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10312 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10313 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010315src : ip
10316 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10317 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10318 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10319 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10320 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10321 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10322 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010323
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010324 Example:
10325 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10326 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010328src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10329 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10330 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10331 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010332 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010334src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10335 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10336 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010337 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010338 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010340src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10341 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10342 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10343 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10344 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10345 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10346 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010347
10348 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10349 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10350 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10351 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010352 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010353 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10354 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010356src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010357 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010358 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010359 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010360 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010362src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010363 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010364 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10365 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010366 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010368src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10369 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10370 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10371 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010372 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010374src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010375 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010376 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010377 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010378 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010380src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010381 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010382 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010383 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10384 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010385 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10386 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10387 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010389src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10390 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10391 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010392 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010393 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010394 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010396src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10397 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10398 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10399 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10400 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010401 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010403src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10404 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10405 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10406 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010407 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010409src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10410 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10411 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10412 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010413 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010414 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010416src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10417 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10418 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10419 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010420 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010421 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10422 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010423
10424 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010425 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010426 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010428src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10429 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10430 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10431 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10432 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010433 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10434 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010436src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10437 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10438 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010439 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10440 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010441 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010443src_port : integer
10444 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10445 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10446 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10447 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010449src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10450 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010451 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10452 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10453 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010454 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010456src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10457 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10458 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10459 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10460 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010461 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010463src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10464 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10465 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10466 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10467 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10468 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10469 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10470 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10471 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010472
10473 Example :
10474 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10475 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10476 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10477 listen ssh
10478 bind :22
10479 mode tcp
10480 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010481 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010482 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010483 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010485srv_id : integer
10486 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10487 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10488 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010489
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010490
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200104917.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010492----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010494The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10495closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10496when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10497usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010498future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010499
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010500ssl_bc : boolean
10501 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10502 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10503 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10504
10505ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10506 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10507 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10508
10509ssl_bc_cipher : string
10510 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10511 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10512
10513ssl_bc_protocol : string
10514 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10515 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10516
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010517ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010518 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010519 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10520 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010521
10522ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10523 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10524 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10525 if session was reused or not.
10526
10527ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10528 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10529 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010531ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10532 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10533 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10534 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10535 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10536 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010538ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10539 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10540 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10541 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10542 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010544ssl_c_err : integer
10545 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10546 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10547 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10548 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10549 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010551ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10552 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10553 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10554 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10555 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10556 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10557 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10558 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10559 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010561ssl_c_key_alg : string
10562 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10563 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10564 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010566ssl_c_notafter : string
10567 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10568 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10569 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010571ssl_c_notbefore : string
10572 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10573 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10574 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010576ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10577 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10578 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10579 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10580 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10581 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10582 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10583 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10584 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010586ssl_c_serial : binary
10587 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10588 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10589 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010591ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10592 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10593 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10594 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010596ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10597 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10598 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10599 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010601ssl_c_used : boolean
10602 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10603 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010605ssl_c_verify : integer
10606 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10607 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10608 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10609 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010611ssl_c_version : integer
10612 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10613 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010615ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10616 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10617 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10618 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10619 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010620 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010621 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10622 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10623 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010625ssl_f_key_alg : string
10626 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10627 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10628 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010630ssl_f_notafter : string
10631 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10632 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10633 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010635ssl_f_notbefore : string
10636 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10637 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10638 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010640ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10641 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10642 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10643 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10644 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10645 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10646 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10647 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10648 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010650ssl_f_serial : binary
10651 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10652 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10653 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010654
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010655ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10656 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10657 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10658 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010660ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10661 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10662 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10663 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010665ssl_f_version : integer
10666 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10667 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10668
10669ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010670 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10671 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10672 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010674 Example :
10675 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10676 listen http-https
10677 bind :80
10678 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10679 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10680
10681ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10682 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10683 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10684
10685ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010686 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010687 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10688 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10689 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10690 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10691 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10692 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10693 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10694 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010696ssl_fc_cipher : string
10697 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10698 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010700ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010701 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10702 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010703 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10704 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10705 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10706 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010708ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10709 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010710 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10711 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10712 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10713 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010715ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010716 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010717 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10718 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10719 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10720 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10721 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10722 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10723 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010725ssl_fc_protocol : string
10726 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10727 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010728
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010729ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010730 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010731 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10732 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010734ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10735 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10736 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10737 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10738 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010740ssl_fc_sni : string
10741 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10742 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10743 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10744 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10745 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10746
10747 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10748 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10749 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010750 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10751 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010753 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010754 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10755 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010757ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10758 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10759 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010760
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010761
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200107627.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010763------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010765Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10766sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10767only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10768For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10769be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10770can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10771sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10772for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10773content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010775payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10776 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10777 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10778 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010780payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10781 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10782 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10783 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010785req.len : integer
10786req_len : integer (deprecated)
10787 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10788 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10789 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10790 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10791 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10792 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10793 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10794 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010796req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10797 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010798 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10799 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10800 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10801 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010803 ACL alternatives :
10804 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010806req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10807 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10808 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10809 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10810 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010812 ACL alternatives :
10813 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010815 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010817req.proto_http : boolean
10818req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10819 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10820 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10821 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10822 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10823 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10824 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10825 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010827 Example:
10828 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10829 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10830 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010831 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010833req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10834rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10835 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10836 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10837 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10838 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10839 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10840 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10841 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010843 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10844 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10845 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10846 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10847 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10848 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010850 ACL derivatives :
10851 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010853 Example :
10854 listen tse-farm
10855 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10856 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10857 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10858 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10859 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10860 persist rdp-cookie
10861 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10862 # This is only useful makes sense if
10863 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10864 stick-table type string size 204800
10865 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10866 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10867 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010869 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10870 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010872req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10873rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10874 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10875 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10876 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10877 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010879 ACL derivatives :
10880 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010882req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10883req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10884 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10885 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10886 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10887 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10888 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10889 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10890 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010892req.ssl_sni : string
10893req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10894 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10895 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10896 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10897 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10898 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10899 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10900 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10901 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10902 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10903 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10904 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10905 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010907 ACL derivatives :
10908 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010910 Examples :
10911 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10912 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10913 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10914 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10915 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010917res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10918rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10919 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10920 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10921 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10922 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10923 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10924 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10925 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010927req.ssl_ver : integer
10928req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10929 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10930 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10931 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10932 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10933 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10934 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10935 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10936 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10937 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010939 ACL derivatives :
10940 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010941
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010942res.len : integer
10943 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10944 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10945 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10946 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10947 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10948 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10949 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10950 content inspection.
10951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010952res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10953 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010954 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10955 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10956 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10957 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010959res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10960 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10961 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10962 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10963 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010965 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010967wait_end : boolean
10968 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10969 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10970 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10971 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10972 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10973 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10974 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10975 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010977 Examples :
10978 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10979 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10980 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010982 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10983 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10984 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10985 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10986 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10987 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10988 tcp-request content reject
10989
10990
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010992--------------------------------------
10993
10994It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10995This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10996data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10997its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10998HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10999content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11000to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11001more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11002response are indexed.
11003
11004base : string
11005 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11006 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11007 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11008 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11009 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11010 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11011 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11012 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11013
11014 ACL derivatives :
11015 base : exact string match
11016 base_beg : prefix match
11017 base_dir : subdir match
11018 base_dom : domain match
11019 base_end : suffix match
11020 base_len : length match
11021 base_reg : regex match
11022 base_sub : substring match
11023
11024base32 : integer
11025 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11026 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11027 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11028 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11029
11030base32+src : binary
11031 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11032 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11033 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11034 per-URL counters.
11035
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011036capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11037 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11038 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11039 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11040
11041capture.req.method : string
11042 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11043 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11044 because it's allocated.
11045
11046capture.req.uri : string
11047 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11048 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11049 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11050 allocated.
11051
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011052capture.req.ver : string
11053 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11054 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11055 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11056
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011057capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11058 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11059 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11060 The first entry is an index of 0.
11061 See also: "capture response header"
11062
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011063capture.res.ver : string
11064 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11065 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11066 persistent flag.
11067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011068req.cook([<name>]) : string
11069cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11070 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11071 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11072 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11073 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11074 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11075 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11076 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11077 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11078
11079 ACL derivatives :
11080 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11081 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11082 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11083 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11084 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11085 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11086 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11087 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011089req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11090cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11091 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11092 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011094req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11095cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11096 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11097 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11098 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11099 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011101cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11102 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11103 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11104 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11105 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11106 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11107 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11108 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11109 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11110 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11111 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011113hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11114 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11115 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11116 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11117 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011118 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011120req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11121 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11122 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11123 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11124 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11125 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11126 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11127 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11128 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011130req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11131 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11132 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11133 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11134 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011136req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11137 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11138 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11139 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11140 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11141 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11142 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11143 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11144 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11145 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11146 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11147 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011149 ACL derivatives :
11150 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11151 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11152 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11153 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11154 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11155 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11156 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11157 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11158
11159req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11160hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11161 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11162 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11163 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11164 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11165 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11166 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11167 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11168 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11169 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11170
11171req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11172hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11173 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11174 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11175 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11176 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11177 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11178 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11179 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11180 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11181
11182req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11183hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11184 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11185 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11186 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11187 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11188 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11189 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11190 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11191
11192http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11193 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11194 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11195 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11196 basic auth is supported.
11197
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011198http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11199 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11200 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11201 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11202 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011203 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11204 basic auth is supported.
11205
11206 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011207 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11208 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11209 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11210 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011211
11212http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011213 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11214 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011215 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11216 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011218method : integer + string
11219 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11220 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11221 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11222 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11223 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11224 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11225 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011227 ACL derivatives :
11228 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011230 Example :
11231 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11232 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11233 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011235path : string
11236 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11237 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11238 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11239 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11240 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11241 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11242 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011244 ACL derivatives :
11245 path : exact string match
11246 path_beg : prefix match
11247 path_dir : subdir match
11248 path_dom : domain match
11249 path_end : suffix match
11250 path_len : length match
11251 path_reg : regex match
11252 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011254req.ver : string
11255req_ver : string (deprecated)
11256 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11257 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11258 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011260 ACL derivatives :
11261 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011263res.comp : boolean
11264 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11265 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11266 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011268res.comp_algo : string
11269 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11270 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11271 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011273res.cook([<name>]) : string
11274scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11275 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11276 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11277 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011279 ACL derivatives :
11280 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011282res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11283scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11284 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11285 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11286 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011288res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11289scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11290 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11291 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11292 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011294res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11295 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11296 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11297 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11298 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11299 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11300 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11301 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11302 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11303 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011305res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11306 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11307 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11308 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11309 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11310 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011312res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11313shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11314 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11315 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11316 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11317 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11318 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11319 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11320 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11321 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011323 ACL derivatives :
11324 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11325 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11326 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11327 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11328 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11329 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11330 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11331 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11332
11333res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11334shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11335 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11336 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11337 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11338 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11339 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011341res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11342shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11343 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11344 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11345 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11346 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11347 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11348 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011350res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11351shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11352 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11353 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11354 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11355 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11356 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11357 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011359res.ver : string
11360resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11361 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11362 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011364 ACL derivatives :
11365 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011367set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11368 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11369 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11370 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11371 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011373 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11374 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011376 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011378status : integer
11379 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11380 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11381 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011383url : string
11384 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11385 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11386 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11387 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11388 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11389 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11390 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011392 ACL derivatives :
11393 url : exact string match
11394 url_beg : prefix match
11395 url_dir : subdir match
11396 url_dom : domain match
11397 url_end : suffix match
11398 url_len : length match
11399 url_reg : regex match
11400 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011402url_ip : ip
11403 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11404 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11405 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11406 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11407 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11408 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11409 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011411url_port : integer
11412 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11413 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11414 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11415 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011417urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11418url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11419 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11420 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11421 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11422 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11423 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11424 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11425 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11426 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11427 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011429 ACL derivatives :
11430 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11431 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11432 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11433 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11434 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11435 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11436 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11437 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011438
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011440 Example :
11441 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11442 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11443 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11444 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011446urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11447 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11448 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11449 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011450
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114527.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011453---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011455Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11456every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011457order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011458
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011459ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11460---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011461FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011462HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011463HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11464HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011465HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11466HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11467HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11468HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11469LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011470METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11471METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11472METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11473METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11474METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11475METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011476RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011477REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011478TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011479WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11480---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011481
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114838. Logging
11484----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011485
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011486One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11487provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11488very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11489provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11490state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011491to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011492headers.
11493
11494In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11495about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11496send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11497
11498 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11499 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11500 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11501 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11502 at the termination.
11503
11504The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11505allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11506as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11507while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11508real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11509delay.
11510
11511
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115128.1. Log levels
11513---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011514
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011515TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011516source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011517HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11518in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11519track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11520syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11521about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011522
11523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115248.2. Log formats
11525----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011526
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011527HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011528and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11529slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11530options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011531
11532 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11533 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11534 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11535 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11536 extents.
11537
11538 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11539 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11540 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11541 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11542 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11543
11544 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11545 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11546 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11547 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11548 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11549
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011550 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11551 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11552 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11553 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11554
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011555 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11556
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011557Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11558specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11559field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11560servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11561always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11562identifier.
11563
11564Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11565 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11566 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11567 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11568 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11569
11570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115718.2.1. Default log format
11572-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011573
11574This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11575as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11576format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11577
11578 Example :
11579 listen www
11580 mode http
11581 log global
11582 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11583
11584 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11585 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11586 (www/HTTP)
11587
11588 Field Format Extract from the example above
11589 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11590 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11591 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11592 4 'to' to
11593 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11594 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11595
11596Detailed fields description :
11597 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11598 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11599 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11600 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11601 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11602 and processed the connection.
11603 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11604
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011605In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11606"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11607connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11608
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011609It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11610will eventually disappear.
11611
11612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116138.2.2. TCP log format
11614---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011615
11616The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11617is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11618information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11619counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11620emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11621environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11622the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11623sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011624specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11625not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11626fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11627marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011628
11629 Example :
11630 frontend fnt
11631 mode tcp
11632 option tcplog
11633 log global
11634 default_backend bck
11635
11636 backend bck
11637 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11638
11639 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11640 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11641 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11642
11643 Field Format Extract from the example above
11644 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11645 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11646 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11647 4 frontend_name fnt
11648 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11649 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11650 7 bytes_read* 212
11651 8 termination_state --
11652 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11653 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11654
11655Detailed fields description :
11656 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011657 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11658 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11659 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11660 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11661 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011662
11663 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011664 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11665 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11666 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011667
11668 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11669 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11670 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11671 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11672
11673 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11674 and processed the connection.
11675
11676 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11677 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11678 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11679 applications.
11680
11681 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11682 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11683 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11684 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11685 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11686
11687 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11688 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11689 See "Timers" below for more details.
11690
11691 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11692 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11693 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11694 "Timers" below for more details.
11695
11696 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011697 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011698 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11699 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11700 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11701 details.
11702
11703 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11704 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11705 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11706 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11707 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11708
11709 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11710 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11711 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11712 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11713 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11714 for more details.
11715
11716 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011717 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011718 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11719 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11720 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011721 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011722
11723 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11724 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11725 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11726 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11727 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11728 caused by a denial of service attack.
11729
11730 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11731 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11732 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11733 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11734 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11735 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11736 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11737 denial of service attack.
11738
11739 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11740 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11741 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11742 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11743 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11744 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11745 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11746 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11747 be processed than on other servers.
11748
11749 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11750 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11751 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11752 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11753 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11754 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11755 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11756 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11757 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11758 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11759 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11760 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11761 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11762
11763 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11764 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11765 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11766 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11767 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11768 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11769 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11770 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11771
11772 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11773 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11774 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11775 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11776 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11777 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11778 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11779 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11780 occurs.
11781
11782
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117838.2.3. HTTP log format
11784----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011785
11786The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11787is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11788the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11789are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11790emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11791generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11792"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11793which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011794frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11795is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011796
11797Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11798slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11799with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11800
11801 Example :
11802 frontend http-in
11803 mode http
11804 option httplog
11805 log global
11806 default_backend bck
11807
11808 backend static
11809 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11810
11811 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11812 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11813 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011814 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011815
11816 Field Format Extract from the example above
11817 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11818 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11819 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11820 4 frontend_name http-in
11821 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11822 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11823 7 status_code 200
11824 8 bytes_read* 2750
11825 9 captured_request_cookie -
11826 10 captured_response_cookie -
11827 11 termination_state ----
11828 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11829 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11830 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11831 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11832 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011833
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011834
11835Detailed fields description :
11836 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011837 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11838 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11839 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11840 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11841 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011842
11843 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011844 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11845 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11846 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011847
11848 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11849 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11850 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11851 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11852 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11853
11854 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11855 and processed the connection.
11856
11857 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11858 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11859 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11860
11861 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11862 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11863 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11864 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11865 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11866 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11867
11868 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11869 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11870 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11871 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11872 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11873 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11874
11875 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11876 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11877 See "Timers" below for more details.
11878
11879 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11880 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11881 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11882 below for more details.
11883
11884 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11885 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11886 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11887 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11888 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11889 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11890 for more details.
11891
11892 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011893 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011894 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11895 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11896 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11897 details.
11898
11899 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11900 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11901 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11902
11903 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11904 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11905 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11906 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11907 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11908 overflowing.
11909
11910 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11911 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11912 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11913 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11914 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11915 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11916 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11917 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11918
11919 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11920 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11921 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11922 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11923 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11924 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11925 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11926 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11927
11928 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11929 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11930 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11931 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11932 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11933 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11934 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11935
11936 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011937 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011938 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11939 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11940 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011941 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011942 system.
11943
11944 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11945 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11946 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11947 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11948 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11949 caused by a denial of service attack.
11950
11951 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11952 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11953 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11954 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11955 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11956 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11957 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11958 denial of service attack.
11959
11960 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11961 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11962 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11963 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11964 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11965 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11966 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11967 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11968 processed than on other servers.
11969
11970 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11971 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11972 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11973 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11974 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11975 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11976 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11977 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11978 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11979 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11980 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11981 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11982 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11983
11984 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11985 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11986 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11987 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11988 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11989 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11990 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11991 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11992
11993 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11994 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11995 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11996 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11997 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11998 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11999 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12000 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12001 occurs.
12002
12003 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12004 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12005 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12006 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12007 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12008 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12009 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12010 cookies" below for more details.
12011
12012 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12013 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12014 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12015 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12016 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12017 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12018 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12019 and cookies" below for more details.
12020
12021 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12022 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12023 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12024 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12025 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12026 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12027 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12028 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12029
12030
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200120318.2.4. Custom log format
12032------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012033
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012034The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012035mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012036
12037HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12038Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12039separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12040prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12041
12042Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12043variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12044string formats ("Q").
12045
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012046If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012047as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012048less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12049the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12050
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012051Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012052In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012053in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012054
12055Flags are :
12056 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012057 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012058
12059 Example:
12060
12061 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12062 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12063
12064At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12065
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012066 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12067 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012068
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012069the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012070
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012071 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012072 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012073 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012074
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012075and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12076
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012077 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012078 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12079
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012080Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12081
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012082 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012083 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012084 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12085 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12086 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012087 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12088 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12089 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012090 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012091 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012092 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012093 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012094 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012095 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012096 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12097 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012098 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012099 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12100 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012101 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012102 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12103 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012104 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12105 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12106 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012107 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012108 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12109 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012110 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012111 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12112 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12113 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012114 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012115 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12116 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12117 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12118 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012119 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012120 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012121 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012122 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012123 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012124 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012125 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12126 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12127 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012128 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012129 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12130 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012131 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012132 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012133 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012134 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012135
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012136 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012137
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012138
121398.2.5. Error log format
12140-----------------------
12141
12142When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12143protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12144By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12145"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12146will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12147logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12148
12149The format looks like this :
12150
12151 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12152 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12153 Connection error during SSL handshake
12154
12155 Field Format Extract from the example above
12156 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12157 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12158 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12159 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12160 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12161
12162These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12163failures.
12164
12165
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121668.3. Advanced logging options
12167-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012168
12169Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12170just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12171options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12172for more information about their usage.
12173
12174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121758.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12176------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012177
12178It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12179haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12180commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12181monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12182ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12183
12184 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12185 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12186 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12187 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12188
12189 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12190 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12191 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012192 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012193 such as other load-balancers.
12194
12195 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12196 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12197 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12198
12199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122008.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12201----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012202
12203The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12204what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12205or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12206"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12207just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12208log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12209after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12210is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12211with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12212with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12213
12214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122158.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12216------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012217
12218Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12219for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12220"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12221retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12222raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12223a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12224file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12225you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12226"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12227
12228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122298.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12230--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012231
12232Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12233multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12234them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12235"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12236logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12237error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12238and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12239too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12240useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12241alternative.
12242
12243
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122448.4. Timing events
12245------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012246
12247Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12248reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12249the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12250frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12251mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12252
12253 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12254 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12255 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12256 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12257 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12258
12259 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12260 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12261 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12262 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12263 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12264
12265 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12266 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12267 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12268 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12269 connection never established.
12270
12271 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12272 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12273 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12274 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12275 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12276 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12277 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12278 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12279 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12280 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12281 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12282
12283 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12284 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12285 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12286 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012287 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012288
12289 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12290
12291 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12292 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12293 negative.
12294
12295These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12296protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12297that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012298due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012299close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12300session has been aborted on timeout.
12301
12302Most common cases :
12303
12304 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12305 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12306 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12307 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12308 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12309 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12310 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12311 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12312 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012313 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12314 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12315 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012316
12317 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12318 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12319 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12320 of ms on remote networks.
12321
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012322 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12323 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12324 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012325
12326 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12327 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12328 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12329 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12330 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12331 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12332 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12333 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12334 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12335 to the server until another one is released.
12336
12337Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12338
12339 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12340 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12341 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12342
12343 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12344 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12345 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12346
12347 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12348 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12349 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12350 flags.
12351
12352 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12353 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12354 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12355 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12356 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12357 the client connection was maintained open.
12358
12359 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012360 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012361 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12362 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12363
12364
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123658.5. Session state at disconnection
12366-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012367
12368TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12369"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
123702-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12371each of which has a special meaning :
12372
12373 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12374 session to terminate :
12375
12376 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12377
12378 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12379 server explicitly refused it.
12380
12381 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12382 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12383 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12384 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012385 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12386
12387 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12388 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012389
12390 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12391 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12392 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12393 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12394 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12395
12396 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12397 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12398 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12399 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12400 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12401
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012402 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12403 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12404
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012405 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12406 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12407 backup connections when going up.
12408
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012409 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12410
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012411 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12412 send or receive data.
12413
12414 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12415 send or receive data.
12416
12417 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12418 with nothing left in the buffers.
12419
12420 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12421
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012422 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012423 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12424
12425 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12426 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12427 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12428 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12429 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12430
12431 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12432 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12433
12434 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12435 server (HTTP only).
12436
12437 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12438
12439 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12440 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12441 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12442
12443 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12444 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12445 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12446
12447 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12448
12449 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12450 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12451
12452 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12453 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12454 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12455
12456 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12457 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012458 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12459 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012460
12461 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12462 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12463 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12464 another server.
12465
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012466 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012467 server.
12468
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012469 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12470 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12471 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12472 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12473
12474 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12475 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12476 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12477 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12478
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012479 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12480 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12481 "use-server" rule).
12482
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012483 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12484
12485 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12486 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12487
12488 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12489
12490 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12491 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12492 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12493
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012494 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12495 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012496 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012497 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12498 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12499
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012500 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12501
12502 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12503 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12504
12505 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12506
12507 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12508
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012509The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12510was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012511helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12512starvation, attacks, etc...
12513
12514The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12515alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12516easier finding and understanding.
12517
12518 Flags Reason
12519
12520 -- Normal termination.
12521
12522 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12523 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12524 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12525 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12526
12527 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12528 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12529 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12530 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12531 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12532 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012533
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012534 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12535 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012536 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012537
12538 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12539 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12540 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12541
12542 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12543 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12544 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12545 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12546 the server takes too long to respond.
12547
12548 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12549 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12550 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12551 long a time to respond.
12552
12553 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12554 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12555 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12556 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12557 and the client.
12558
12559 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12560 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12561 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12562 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12563 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012564 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
12565 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
12566 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
12567 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
12568 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
12569 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
12570 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
12571 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
12572 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
12573 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
12574 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
12575 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
12576 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
12577 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012578
12579 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12580 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012581 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12582 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12583 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12584 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012585
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012586 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12587 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012589 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012590 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12591 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12592 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12593 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12594 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12595
12596 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12597 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12598 503 or 504 here.
12599
12600 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12601 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12602 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12603 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12604 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12605
12606 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12607 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012608 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012609 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12610 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12611
12612 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12613 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12614 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12615 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12616 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12617 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12618 between haproxy and the server.
12619
12620 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12621 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12622 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12623 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12624 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12625 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12626 solution is to fix the application.
12627
12628 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12629 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12630 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12631 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12632 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12633 external attacks.
12634
12635 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12636 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012637 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012638 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12639 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12640
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012641 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12642 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12643 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012644 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12645 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012646
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012647 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12648 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12649 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12650 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012651 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12652 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12653 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12654 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12655 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012656
12657 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12658 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12659 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12660 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12661
12662 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12663 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12664 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12665 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12666
12667 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12668 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12669 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12670 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12671
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012672The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12673persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12674important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12675re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12676
12677 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12678
12679 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12680 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12681 set on a GET request.
12682
12683 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12684 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012685 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012686 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12687
12688 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12689 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12690 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12691
12692 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12693 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12694 already got a cookie.
12695
12696 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12697 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12698 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12699 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12700 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12701
12702 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12703 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12704 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12705
12706 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12707 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12708 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12709
12710 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12711 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12712
12713 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12714 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12715 then advertised in the response.
12716
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127188.6. Non-printable characters
12719-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012720
12721In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12722consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12723converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12724prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12725being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12726escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12727is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12728'}' when logging headers.
12729
12730Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12731issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12732containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12733
12734Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12735the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12736performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12737
12738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127398.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12740---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012741
12742Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12743achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012744section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012745cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12746the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12747the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012748locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012749not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12750user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12751a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12752wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12753
12754 Examples :
12755 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12756 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12757
12758 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12759 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12760
12761
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127628.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12763---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012764
12765Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12766proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12767the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12768server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12769
12770Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12771response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012772section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012773
12774It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012775time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12776appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012777are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12778and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12779follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12780request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12781in the logs.
12782
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012783As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
12784frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
12785an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
12786
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012787 Example :
12788 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12789 listen proxy-out
12790 mode http
12791 option httplog
12792 option logasap
12793 log global
12794 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12795
12796 # log the name of the virtual server
12797 capture request header Host len 20
12798
12799 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12800 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12801
12802 # log the beginning of the referrer
12803 capture request header Referer len 20
12804
12805 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12806 capture response header Server len 20
12807
12808 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12809 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12810
12811 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12812 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12813
12814 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12815 capture response header Via len 20
12816
12817 # log the URL location during a redirection
12818 capture response header Location len 20
12819
12820 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12821 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12822 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12823 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12824 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12825
12826 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12827 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12828 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12829 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012830 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012831
12832 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12833 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12834 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12835 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12836 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012837 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012838
12839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128408.9. Examples of logs
12841---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012842
12843These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12844them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12845reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12846
12847 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12848 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12849 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12850
12851 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12852 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12853
12854 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12855 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12856 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12857
12858 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12859 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12860
12861 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12862 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12863 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12864
12865 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012866 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012867 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12868 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12869
12870 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12871 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12872 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12873
12874 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12875 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012876 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012877 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12878 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12879 to return the 502 and not the server.
12880
12881 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012882 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012883
12884 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12885 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12886 Nothing was sent to any server.
12887
12888 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12889 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12890
12891 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12892 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12893 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12894 send a 408 return code to the client.
12895
12896 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12897 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12898
12899 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12900 5 seconds ("c----").
12901
12902 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12903 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012904 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012905
12906 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012907 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012908 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12909 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12910 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12911 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12912 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012913
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012914
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129159. Statistics and monitoring
12916----------------------------
12917
12918It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12919mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12920CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12921Unix socket.
12922
12923
129249.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012925---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012926
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012927The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12928page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012930 0. pxname: proxy name
12931 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12932 for server)
12933 2. qcur: current queued requests
12934 3. qmax: max queued requests
12935 4. scur: current sessions
12936 5. smax: max sessions
12937 6. slim: sessions limit
12938 7. stot: total sessions
12939 8. bin: bytes in
12940 9. bout: bytes out
12941 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012942 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012943 12. ereq: request errors
12944 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012945 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012946 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12947 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012948 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012949 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12950 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12951 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12952 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12953 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12954 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12955 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12956 25. qlimit: queue limit
12957 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12958 27. iid: unique proxy id
12959 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12960 29. throttle: warm up status
12961 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12962 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012963 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012964 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12965 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12966 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012967 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012968 UNK -> unknown
12969 INI -> initializing
12970 SOCKERR -> socket error
12971 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12972 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12973 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12974 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12975 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12976 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12977 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12978 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12979 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12980 disable-on-404
12981 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12982 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12983 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012984 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12985 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012986 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12987 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12988 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12989 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12990 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12991 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012992 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12993 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12994 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12995 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012996 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12997 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012998 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12999 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13000 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010013001 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010013002 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013003
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130059.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013006-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013007
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013008The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13009necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13010A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13011issuing commands by hand :
13012
13013 global
13014 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13015 stats timeout 2m
13016
13017It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13018the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13019never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13020situations :
13021
13022 global
13023 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13024 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13025 stats timeout 2m
13026
13027To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13028swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13029to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13030syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13031
13032 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13033 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13034
13035The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13036script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13037for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13038
13039The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13040that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13041editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13042(eg: watch a counter).
13043
13044The socket supports two operation modes :
13045 - interactive
13046 - non-interactive
13047
13048The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13049this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13050sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13051mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13052commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13053example :
13054
13055 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13056
13057The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13058entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13059for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13060sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13061"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13062after processing the last command of the same line.
13063
13064For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13065"prompt" command :
13066
13067 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13068 prompt
13069 > show info
13070 ...
13071 >
13072
13073Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13074delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13075that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13076parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013077
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013078It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13079on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13080own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013081
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013082The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13083If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13084all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13085it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13086
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013087add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013088 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13089 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13090 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13091 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013092
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013093add map <map> <key> <value>
13094 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13095 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013096 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13097 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13098 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013099
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013100clear counters
13101 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13102 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13103 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13104 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13105 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13106
13107clear counters all
13108 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13109 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13110 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13111
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013112clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013113 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13114 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13115 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013116
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013117clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013118 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13119 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13120 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013121
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013122clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13123 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13124
13125 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13126 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13127 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13128 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13129 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13130 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13131
13132 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13133
13134 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13135 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13136 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13137 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13138 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13139 the ACLs :
13140
13141 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13142 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13143 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13144 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13145 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13146 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13147
13148 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013149 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13150 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013151
13152 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013153 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013154 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013155 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13156 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13157 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13158 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013159
13160 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13161
13162 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013163 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013164 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13165 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013166 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13167 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13168 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013169
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013170del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13171 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013172 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13173 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13174 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13175 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013176
13177del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013178 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013179 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13180 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13181 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13182 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013183
13184disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013185 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13186
13187 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13188 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13189 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13190 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13191 re-enabled using enable agent.
13192
13193 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13194 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13195 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13196 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13197 otherwise unchanged.
13198
13199 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13200 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13201 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13202
13203 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13204 level "admin".
13205
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013206disable frontend <frontend>
13207 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13208 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13209 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13210 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13211 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13212 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13213 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13214 on the stats page.
13215
13216 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13217 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13218
13219 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13220 level "admin".
13221
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013222disable health <backend>/<server>
13223 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13224 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13225 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13226 agent check forces it down.
13227
13228 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13229 level "admin".
13230
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013231disable server <backend>/<server>
13232 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13233 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13234 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13235 during the maintenance.
13236
13237 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13238 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13239
13240 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013241 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013242
13243 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13244 level "admin".
13245
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013246enable agent <backend>/<server>
13247 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13248
13249 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13250 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13251
13252 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13253 level "admin".
13254
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013255enable frontend <frontend>
13256 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13257 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13258 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13259 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13260 which was disabled.
13261
13262 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13263 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13264
13265 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13266 level "admin".
13267
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013268enable health <backend>/<server>
13269 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13270 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13271
13272 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13273 level "admin".
13274
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013275enable server <backend>/<server>
13276 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13277 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13278
13279 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013280 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013281
13282 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13283 level "admin".
13284
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013285get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013286get acl <acl> <value>
13287 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13288 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13289 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13290 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13291 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013292
13293 The first two words are:
13294
13295 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13296 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13297 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13298
13299 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13300
13301 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13302
13303 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13304
13305 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13306 interpretation of the case.
13307
13308 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13309 useful with regular expressions.
13310
13311 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13312 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13313
13314 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13315 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13316 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13317
13318 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13319
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013320get weight <backend>/<server>
13321 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13322 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13323 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13324 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13325 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013326 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013327
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013328help
13329 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13330 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013331
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013332prompt
13333 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13334 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13335 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13336 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13337 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13338 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13339 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13340 command.
13341
13342quit
13343 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013344
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013345set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013346 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13347 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13348 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013349
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013350set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013351 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13352 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13353 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13354 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13355 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013356 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13357 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13358
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013359set maxconn global <maxconn>
13360 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13361 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13362 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13363 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13364 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13365 setting.
13366
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013367set rate-limit connections global <value>
13368 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13369 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13370 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13371 is passed in number of connections per second.
13372
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013373set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13374 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13375 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013376 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13377 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013378
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013379set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13380 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13381 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13382 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13383 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13384
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013385set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13386 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13387 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13388 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13389 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13390 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13391
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013392set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13393 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13394 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13395 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13396
13397set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13398 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13399 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13400 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13401
13402set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13403 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13404 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13405 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13406 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13407 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13408 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13409 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13410 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13411
13412set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13413 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13414 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13415
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013416set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013417 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13418 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13419 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13420 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013421 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13422 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013423
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013424set timeout cli <delay>
13425 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13426 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13427 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13428
13429set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13430 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13431 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013432 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13433 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13434 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13435 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13436 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13437 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13438 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13439 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13440 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13441 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13442 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13443 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13444 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013445
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013446show errors [<iid>]
13447 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13448 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013449 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13450 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13451 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013452
13453 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13454 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13455 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13456 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13457 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13458 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13459 are reported too.
13460
13461 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13462 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13463 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13464 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13465 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13466 code.
13467
13468 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13469 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13470 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13471 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13472 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13473 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13474 line.
13475
13476 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013477 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13478 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013479 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13480 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13481
13482 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13483 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13484 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13485 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13486 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13487 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13488 00204+ minal\r\n
13489 00211 \r\n
13490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013491 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013492 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13493 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13494 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13495 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13496 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13497 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013498
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013499show info
13500 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13501
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013502show map [<map>]
13503 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013504 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13505 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13506 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13507 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13508 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13509 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013510
13511show acl [<acl>]
13512 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013513 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13514 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13515 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13516 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13517 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013518
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013519show pools
13520 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13521 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13522 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13523 the pools.
13524
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013525show sess
13526 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013527 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13528 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13529
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013530show sess <id>
13531 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13532 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13533 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13534 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13535 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013536 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13537 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13538 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013539
13540show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13541 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13542 possible to dump only selected items :
13543 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13544 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13545 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13546 for example:
13547 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13548 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13549 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13550
13551 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013552 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13553 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013554 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13555 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13556 Nbproc: 1
13557 Process_num: 1
13558 (...)
13559
13560 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13561 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13562 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13563 (...)
13564 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13565
13566 $
13567
13568 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13569 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13570 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13571 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013572 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013573
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013574show table
13575 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13576 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13577 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13578 entries currently in use.
13579
13580 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013581 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013582 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13583 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013584
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013585show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013586 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13587 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13588 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013589 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13590
13591 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13592 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13593 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13594 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13595 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13596
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013597 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13598 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13599 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13600 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13601 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13602 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13603
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013604
13605 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013606 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13607 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013608
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013609 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013610 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013611 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013612 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13613 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13614 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13615 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013616
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013617 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013618 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013619 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13620 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013621
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013622 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13623 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013624 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013625 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13626 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013627
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013628 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13629 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013630 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013631 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13632 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13633
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013634 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13635 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13636 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13637 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13638 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13639
13640 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13641 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13642 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013643 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13644 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013645 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13646 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013647
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013648shutdown frontend <frontend>
13649 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13650 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13651 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13652 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13653 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13654 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13655 once it is terminated.
13656
13657 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13658 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13659
13660 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13661 level "admin".
13662
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013663shutdown session <id>
13664 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13665 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13666 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13667 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13668 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13669 flag in the logs.
13670
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013671shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13672 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13673 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13674 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13675 'K' flag in the logs.
13676
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013677/*
13678 * Local variables:
13679 * fill-column: 79
13680 * End:
13681 */